blob: 34fff1d78b145cdf245f386bddebd5b88145901c [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau9dc6b972019-06-16 21:49:47 +02005 version 2.1
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaudb514072019-07-16 19:15:28 +02007 2019/07/16
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020055
564. Proxies
574.1. Proxy keywords matrix
584.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
59
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100605. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200615.1. Bind options
625.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200635.3. Server DNS resolution
645.3.1. Global overview
655.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200677. Using ACLs and fetching samples
687.1. ACL basics
697.1.1. Matching booleans
707.1.2. Matching integers
717.1.3. Matching strings
727.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
737.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
747.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
757.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
767.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200777.3.1. Converters
787.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
797.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
807.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
817.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
827.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200837.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020084
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200856. Cache
866.1. Limitation
876.2. Setup
886.2.1. Cache section
896.2.2. Proxy section
90
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200918. Logging
928.1. Log levels
938.2. Log formats
948.2.1. Default log format
958.2.2. TCP log format
968.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100978.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100988.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200998.3. Advanced logging options
1008.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1018.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1028.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1038.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1048.4. Timing events
1058.5. Session state at disconnection
1068.6. Non-printable characters
1078.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1088.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1098.9. Examples of logs
110
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001119. Supported filters
1129.1. Trace
1139.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001149.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001159.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200116
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117
1181. Quick reminder about HTTP
119----------------------------
120
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100121When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
123on almost anything found in the contents.
124
125However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
126formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
127correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
128
129
1301.1. The HTTP transaction model
131-------------------------------
132
133The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100134to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100135from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
136connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137will involve a new connection :
138
139 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
140
141In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
142establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
143by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
144length.
145
146Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
147to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
148however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
149response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
150header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
151
152 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
153
154Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
155power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
156but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200157a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100159Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
161second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
162page :
163
164 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
165
166This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
167latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
168correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
169the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100170server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100172The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
173time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
174are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
175parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
176carry the stream identifier.
177
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100178By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
179connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
180leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100181start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
182processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
183waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200184
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200185HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100186 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
187 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100188 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100189 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200190 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100191
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100192For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
193the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100194server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
195is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
196servers.
197
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198
1991.2. HTTP request
200-----------------
201
202First, let's consider this HTTP request :
203
204 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100205 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
207 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
208 3 User-agent: my small browser
209 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
210 5 Accept: image/png
211
212
2131.2.1. The Request line
214-----------------------
215
216Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
217
218 - a METHOD : GET
219 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
220 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
221
222All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
223which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
224followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
225is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
226desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
227the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
228
229The URI itself can have several forms :
230
231 - A "relative URI" :
232
233 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234
235 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
236 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
237
238 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
239
240 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
241
242 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
243 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
244 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
245 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
246 must accept this form too.
247
248 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
249 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
250 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100251
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200252 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
253 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
254 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
255 other protocols too.
256
257In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
258mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
259on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
260It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
261specific to the language, framework or application in use.
262
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100263HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100264assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100265However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
266received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
267processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
268as well as in server logs.
269
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200270
2711.2.2. The request headers
272--------------------------
273
274The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
275beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
276an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
277Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
278values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
279encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
280the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
281define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
282
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100283Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200284their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100285"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
286as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200287
288The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
289that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
290is one valid form of empty line.
291
292Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
293headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
294about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
295application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
296
297Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000298 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
300 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
301 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
302
303
3041.3. HTTP response
305------------------
306
307An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
308messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
309
310 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100311 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
313 2 Content-length: 350
314 3 Content-Type: text/html
315
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200316As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
317codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
318response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100319continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
320the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
321following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
322sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
323(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
324correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
325such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
326state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
327over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
328if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
329information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200330
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200331
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003321.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200333------------------------
334
335Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
336
337 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
338 - a status code : 200
339 - a reason : OK
340
341The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100342 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
343 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
344 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
345 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
346 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200347
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000348Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100349"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200350found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
351messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
352or "Authentication Required".
353
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100354HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200355
356 Code When / reason
357 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
358 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
359 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
360 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100361 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
362 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363 400 for an invalid or too large request
364 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
365 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200366 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200367 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
368 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
369 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
370 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200371 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200372 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
373 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
374 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
375
376The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3774.2).
378
379
3801.3.2. The response headers
381---------------------------
382
383Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
384the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
385details.
386
387
3882. Configuring HAProxy
389----------------------
390
3912.1. Configuration file format
392------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200393
394HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
395
396 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
397 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
398 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
399 "frontend" and "backend".
400
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100401The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
402referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200403delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100404
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200405
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004062.2. Quoting and escaping
407-------------------------
408
409HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
410many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
411with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
412single quotes.
413
414If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
415them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
416escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
417
418Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
419
420 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
421 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
422 \\ to use a backslash
423 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
424 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
425
426Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
427the interpretation of:
428
429 space as a parameter separator
430 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
431 # hash as a comment start
432
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200433Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
434-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
435backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
436
437Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200438quoting.
439
440Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
441nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
442
443Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
444equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
445
446 Example:
447 # those are equivalents:
448 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
449 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
450 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
451 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
452 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
453
454 # those are equivalents:
455 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
456 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
457 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
458 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
459
460
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004612.3. Environment variables
462--------------------------
463
464HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
465interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
466configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
467optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
468shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
469underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
470
471 Example:
472
473 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
474
475 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
476
477 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
478
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200479Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
480file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200481
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200482* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
483 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
484
485* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
486 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
487 directory.
488
489* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
490
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500491* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200492 processes, separated by semicolons.
493
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500494* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200495 CLI, separated by semicolons.
496
497See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200498
4992.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200500----------------
501
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100502Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100503values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
504otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
505numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
506for every keyword. Supported units are :
507
508 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
509 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
510 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
511 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
512 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
513 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
514
515
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005162.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200517-------------
518
519 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
520 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
521 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
522 global
523 daemon
524 maxconn 256
525
526 defaults
527 mode http
528 timeout connect 5000ms
529 timeout client 50000ms
530 timeout server 50000ms
531
532 frontend http-in
533 bind *:80
534 default_backend servers
535
536 backend servers
537 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
538
539
540 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
541 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
542 global
543 daemon
544 maxconn 256
545
546 defaults
547 mode http
548 timeout connect 5000ms
549 timeout client 50000ms
550 timeout server 50000ms
551
552 listen http-in
553 bind *:80
554 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
555
556
557Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
558
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100559 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200560
561
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005623. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200563--------------------
564
565Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
566are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
567of them have command-line equivalents.
568
569The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
570
571 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200572 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200573 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200574 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200575 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200576 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200577 - description
578 - deviceatlas-json-file
579 - deviceatlas-log-level
580 - deviceatlas-separator
581 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900582 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200583 - gid
584 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100585 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200586 - h1-case-adjust
587 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200588 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200589 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100590 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200591 - lua-load
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200592 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200593 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200594 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200595 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200596 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100597 - presetenv
598 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200599 - uid
600 - ulimit-n
601 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200602 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100603 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200604 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200605 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200606 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200607 - ssl-default-bind-options
608 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200609 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200610 - ssl-default-server-options
611 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100612 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100613 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100614 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100615 - 51degrees-data-file
616 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200617 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200618 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200619 - wurfl-data-file
620 - wurfl-information-list
621 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200622 - wurfl-cache-size
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100623
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200624 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200625 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200626 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200627 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100628 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100629 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100630 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200631 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200632 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200633 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200634 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200635 - noepoll
636 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000637 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200638 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100639 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300640 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000641 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100642 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200643 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200644 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200645 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000646 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000647 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200648 - tune.buffers.limit
649 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200650 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200651 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100652 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200653 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200654 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200655 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100656 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200657 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200658 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100659 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100660 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100661 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100662 - tune.lua.session-timeout
663 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200664 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100665 - tune.maxaccept
666 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200667 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200668 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200669 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100670 - tune.rcvbuf.client
671 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100672 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200673 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100674 - tune.sndbuf.client
675 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100676 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100677 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200678 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100679 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200680 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200681 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100682 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200683 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100684 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200685 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
686 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
687 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100688 - tune.zlib.memlevel
689 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100690
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200691 * Debugging
692 - debug
693 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200694
695
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006963.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200697------------------------------------
698
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200699ca-base <dir>
700 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200701 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
702 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200703
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200704chroot <jail dir>
705 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
706 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
707 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
708 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
709 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100710 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100711
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100712cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
713 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
714 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
715 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
716 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
717 set. These sets have the format
718
719 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
720
721 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100722 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100723 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
724 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100725 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
726 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100727 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100728 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100729 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100730 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100731 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
732 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
733 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
734 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100735
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100736 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
737 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
738 on the machine's word size.
739
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100740 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100741 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
742 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
743 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
744 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
745 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
746 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100747
748 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100749 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
750
751 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
752 # first 4 CPUs
753
754 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
755 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
756 # word size.
757
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100758 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100759 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100760 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
761 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
762 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
763
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100764 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
765 # and so on.
766 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
767 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
768 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
769
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100770 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100771 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
772 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
773 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
774
775 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
776 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
777 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
778
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100779 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
780 # and a thread range.
781 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
782 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
783 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
784
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200785crt-base <dir>
786 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
787 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
788 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
789
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200790daemon
791 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
792 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100793 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
794 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200795
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200796deviceatlas-json-file <path>
797 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100798 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200799
800deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100801 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200802 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
803
804deviceatlas-separator <char>
805 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
806 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
807
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100808deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200809 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
810 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
811 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100812
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900813external-check
814 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
815 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
816 See "option external-check".
817
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200818gid <number>
819 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
820 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
821 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100822 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
823 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200824 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100825
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100826hard-stop-after <time>
827 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
828
829 Arguments :
830 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
831 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
832 SIGUSR1 signal.
833
834 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
835 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
836 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
837
838 Example:
839 global
840 hard-stop-after 30s
841
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200842h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
843 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
844 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
845 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
846 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
847 ajusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
848 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
849 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
850 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
851 specified in a proxy.
852
853 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
854 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
855 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
856 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
857 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
858 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
859 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
860
861 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
862 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
863 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
864 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
865 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
866
867 Example:
868 global
869 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
870
871 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
872 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
873
874h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
875 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
876 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
877 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
878 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
879 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
880 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
881 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
882 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
883
884 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
885 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
886 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
887
888 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
889 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
890
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200891group <group name>
892 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
893 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100894
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200895log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
896 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100897 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100898 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100899 configured with "log global".
900
901 <address> can be one of:
902
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100903 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100904 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
905 port).
906
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100907 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
908 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
909 port).
910
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100911 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100912 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
913 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100914 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100915
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100916 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
917 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
918 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
919 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
920 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
921 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
922 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
923 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
924 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
925 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
926 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
927 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
928 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
929 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100930 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
931 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100932
933 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
934 "fd@2", see above.
935
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +0200936 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
937 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
938 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
939 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
940 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
941
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200942 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
943 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100944
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200945 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
946 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
947 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
948 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
949 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
950 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
951 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
952 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
953 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
954 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100955 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
956 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200957
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200958 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
959 one of the following :
960
961 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
962 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
963
964 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
965 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
966
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100967 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
968 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
969 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
970 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
971 logger consumes.
972
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100973 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
974 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
975 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
976 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
977
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200978 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
979 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
980 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
981 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
982 set with <sample_size> parameter.
983
984 <sample_size>
985 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
986 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
987 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
988 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
989 (see also <ranges> parameter).
990
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100991 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200992
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100993 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
994 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
995 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
996
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100997 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
998 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
999 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1000 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001001
1002 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001003 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1004 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1005 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1006 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1007 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1008 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001009
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001010 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001011
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001012log-send-hostname [<string>]
1013 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1014 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1015 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1016 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1017 the logs.
1018
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001019log-tag <string>
1020 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1021 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1022 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001023 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001024
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001025lua-load <file>
1026 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1027 used multiple times.
1028
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001029master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001030 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1031 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1032 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001033 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001034 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1035 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001036 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1037 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1038 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1039 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1040 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001041
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001042 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001043
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001044mworker-max-reloads <number>
1045 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001046 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001047 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1048 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1049 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1050
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001051nbproc <number>
1052 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1053 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1054 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001055 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1056 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001057 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1058 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001059
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001060nbthread <number>
1061 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001062 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1063 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1064 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1065 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1066 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001067 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1068 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1069 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1070 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1071 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1072 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1073 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001074
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001075pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001076 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001077 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1078 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1079
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001080presetenv <name> <value>
1081 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1082 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1083 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1084 and "unsetenv".
1085
1086resetenv [<name> ...]
1087 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1088 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1089 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1090 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1091 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1092 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1093 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1094 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1095
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001096stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001097 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1098 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1099 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1100 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1101 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1102 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001103 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001104 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1105 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1106 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1107 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001108
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001109server-state-base <directory>
1110 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001111 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1112 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001113
1114server-state-file <file>
1115 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1116 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1117 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1118 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1119 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1120 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1121 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1122 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001123 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1124 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001125
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001126setenv <name> <value>
1127 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1128 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1129 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1130 and "unsetenv".
1131
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001132set-dumpable
1133 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
1134 developer's request. It has no impact on performance nor stability but will
1135 try hard to re-enable core dumps that were possibly disabled by file size
1136 limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations (ulimit -c), or "dumpability"
1137 of a process after changing its UID/GID (such as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable
1138 on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by the current directory's
1139 permissions (check what directory the file is started from), the chroot
1140 directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily disable the chroot
1141 directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location), or any other
1142 system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are notorious
1143 for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable not even
1144 installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often, simply
1145 writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the issue.
1146 When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to re-appear, it's
1147 often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by issuing, for example,
1148 "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it leaves a core where
1149 expected when dying.
1150
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001151ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1152 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1153 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001154 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001155 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001156 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1157 information and recommendations see e.g.
1158 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1159 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1160 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1161 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001162
1163ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1164 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1165 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1166 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1167 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1168 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001169 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1170 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1171 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001172 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001173
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001174ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1175 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1176 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1177 keyword to see available options.
1178
1179 Example:
1180 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001181 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001182
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001183ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1184 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1185 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001186 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001187 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001188 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1189 information and recommendations see e.g.
1190 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1191 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1192 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1193 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1194 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001195
1196ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1197 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1198 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1199 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1200 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1201 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001202 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1203 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1204 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1205 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001206
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001207ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1208 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1209 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1210 keyword to see available options.
1211
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001212ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1213 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1214 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1215 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001216 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001217 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001218 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1219 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1220 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1221 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001222 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1223 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1224 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1225
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001226ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1227 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1228 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1229 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1230
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001231stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1232 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1233 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1234 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001235 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001236 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001237
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001238 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1239 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1240 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001241
1242stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1243 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1244 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001245 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001246
1247stats maxconn <connections>
1248 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1249 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1250
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001251uid <number>
1252 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1253 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1254 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1255 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1256
1257ulimit-n <number>
1258 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1259 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1260 option.
1261
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001262unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1263 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1264
1265 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1266 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1267 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1268 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1269 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1270 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1271 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1272 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1273 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1274 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1275
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001276unsetenv [<name> ...]
1277 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1278 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1279 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1280 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1281 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1282 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1283 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1284
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001285user <user name>
1286 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1287 See also "uid" and "group".
1288
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001289node <name>
1290 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1291
1292 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1293 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1294 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1295 traffic.
1296
1297description <text>
1298 Add a text that describes the instance.
1299
1300 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1301 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1302 "<" and ">" characters.
1303
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100130451degrees-data-file <file path>
1305 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001306 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001307
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001308 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001309 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1310
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000131151degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001312 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1313 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1314 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1315
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001316 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001317 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1318
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200131951degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001320 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1321 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1322
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001323 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1324 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1325
132651degrees-cache-size <number>
1327 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1328 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1329 By default, this cache is disabled.
1330
1331 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001332 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1333
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001334wurfl-data-file <file path>
1335 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1336 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1337
1338 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1339 with USE_WURFL=1.
1340
1341wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1342 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1343 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1344 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1345
1346 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1347
1348 Valid WURFL properties are:
1349 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1350
1351 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1352 device.
1353
1354 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1355 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1356
1357 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1358 particular web request.
1359
1360 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1361 used Libwurfl API version.
1362
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001363 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1364 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1365
1366 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1367 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1368
1369 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1370
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001371 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1372 with USE_WURFL=1.
1373
1374wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1375 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1376 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1377
1378 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1379 with USE_WURFL=1.
1380
1381wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1382 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1383 thus before the chroot.
1384
1385 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1386 with USE_WURFL=1.
1387
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001388wurfl-cache-size <size>
1389 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1390 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001391 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001392 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001393
1394 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1395 with USE_WURFL=1.
1396
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013973.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001398-----------------------
1399
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001400busy-polling
1401 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1402 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1403 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1404 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1405 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1406 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1407 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1408 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1409 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1410 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1411 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1412 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1413 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1414 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1415 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1416 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1417 "poll" pollers.
1418
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001419max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1420 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1421 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1422 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1423 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1424 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1425 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1426 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1427 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1428
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001429maxconn <number>
1430 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1431 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1432 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001433 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1434 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1435 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1436 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001437 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1438 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1439 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1440 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1441 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1442 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001443
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001444maxconnrate <number>
1445 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1446 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1447 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1448 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1449 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1450 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1451 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1452 fairness.
1453
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001454maxcomprate <number>
1455 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001456 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001457 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1458 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1459 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001460 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001461 default value.
1462
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001463maxcompcpuusage <number>
1464 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1465 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1466 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1467 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1468 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1469 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1470 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1471 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1472
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001473maxpipes <number>
1474 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1475 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1476 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1477 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1478 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1479 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1480
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001481maxsessrate <number>
1482 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1483 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1484 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1485 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1486 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1487 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1488 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1489 fairness.
1490
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001491maxsslconn <number>
1492 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1493 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1494 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1495 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1496 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1497 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1498 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001499 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1500 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1501 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1502 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1503 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1504 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1505 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001506
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001507maxsslrate <number>
1508 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1509 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1510 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1511 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1512 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1513 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1514 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1515 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1516 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1517 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1518
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001519maxzlibmem <number>
1520 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1521 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1522 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001523 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1524 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1525 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1526
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001527noepoll
1528 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1529 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001530 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001531
1532nokqueue
1533 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1534 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1535 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1536
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001537noevports
1538 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1539 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1540 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1541 also "nopoll".
1542
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001543nopoll
1544 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1545 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001546 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001547 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1548 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001549
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001550nosplice
1551 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001552 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001553 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001554 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001555 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1556 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1557 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1558 "option splice-response".
1559
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001560nogetaddrinfo
1561 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1562 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1563
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001564noreuseport
1565 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1566 command line argument "-dR".
1567
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001568profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1569 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1570 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1571 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1572 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001573 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001574 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1575 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1576 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1577 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1578
1579 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1580 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1581 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1582 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1583 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001584 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1585 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1586 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1587 CLI.
1588
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001589spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001590 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1591 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1592 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1593 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1594 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1595 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001596
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001597ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001598 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001599 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001600 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1601 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1602 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1603 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1604 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001605 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1606 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001607 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1608 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1609 openssl configuration file uses:
1610 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1611
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001612ssl-mode-async
1613 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001614 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001615 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1616 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1617 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001618 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001619 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001620
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001621tune.buffers.limit <number>
1622 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1623 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1624 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1625 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1626 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001627 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001628 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1629 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1630 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1631 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1632 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1633 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1634 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1635 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1636 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1637
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001638tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1639 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1640 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1641 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1642 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1643
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001644tune.bufsize <number>
1645 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1646 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1647 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1648 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1649 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1650 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1651 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001652 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1653 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1654 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001655 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001656 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1657 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1658 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001659
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001660tune.chksize <number>
1661 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1662 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1663 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1664 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1665 checks whenever possible.
1666
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001667tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1668 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1669 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1670 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1671 this value. The default value is 1.
1672
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001673tune.fail-alloc
1674 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1675 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1676 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1677 gracefully.
1678
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001679tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1680 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1681 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1682 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1683 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1684 change it.
1685
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001686tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1687 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001688 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1689 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001690 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1691 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1692 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1693 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1694 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1695
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001696tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1697 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1698 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1699 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1700 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1701 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1702 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1703 recommended not to change this value.
1704
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001705tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1706 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1707 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1708 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1709 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1710 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1711 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1712 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1713
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001714tune.http.cookielen <number>
1715 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1716 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1717 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1718 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1719 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1720 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1721 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1722 to change this value.
1723
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001724tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001725 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1726 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001727 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001728 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001729 configuration directives too.
1730 The default value is 1024.
1731
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001732tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1733 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1734 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1735 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1736 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1737 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1738 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001739 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1740 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1741 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001742
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001743tune.idletimer <timeout>
1744 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1745 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1746 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1747 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1748 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1749 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001750 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001751 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001752 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1753
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001754tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1755 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1756 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1757 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1758 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1759 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1760 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1761 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1762 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1763 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1764
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001765tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1766 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001767 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001768 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1769 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001770 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001771 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1772 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1773
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001774tune.lua.maxmem
1775 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1776 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1777 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1778 memory.
1779
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001780tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1781 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001782 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1783 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001784 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001785
1786tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1787 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1788 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1789 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1790 check servers.
1791
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001792tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1793 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1794 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1795 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001796 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001797
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001798tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001799 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1800 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1801 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1802 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1803 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1804 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1805 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1806 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1807 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1808 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001809
1810tune.maxpollevents <number>
1811 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1812 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1813 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1814 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1815 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1816
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001817tune.maxrewrite <number>
1818 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1819 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1820 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1821 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1822 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1823 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1824 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1825 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1826 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1827 bufsize.
1828
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001829tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1830 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1831 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1832 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1833 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1834 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1835 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1836 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1837 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1838 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1839 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1840 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1841 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1842 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1843 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1844 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1845 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1846 setting this parameter to 0.
1847
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001848tune.pipesize <number>
1849 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1850 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1851 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1852 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1853 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1854 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1855
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001856tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
1857 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1858 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1859 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
1860 default is 20.
1861
1862tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
1863 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1864 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1865 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
1866 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
1867 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
1868 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001869 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001870
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001871tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1872tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1873 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1874 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1875 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001876 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001877 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001878 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1879 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1880
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001881tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001882 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001883 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1884 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1885 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1886 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1887
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001888tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001889 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001890 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1891 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1892
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001893tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1894tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1895 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1896 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1897 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001898 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001899 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001900 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1901 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1902 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1903 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1904 notifying haproxy again.
1905
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001906tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001907 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1908 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1909 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001910 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001911 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001912 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001913 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1914 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1915 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001916 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1917 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001918
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001919tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001920 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001921 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1922 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1923 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1924 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1925 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1926
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001927tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1928 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001929 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001930 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1931 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1932 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1933 being used for too long.
1934
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001935tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1936 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1937 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1938 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1939 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1940 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1941 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1942 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1943 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1944 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1945 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001946 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001947 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001948
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001949tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1950 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1951 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1952 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1953 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1954 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1955 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1956 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001957 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1958 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001959
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001960tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1961 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1962 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1963 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1964 1000 entries.
1965
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001966tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1967 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1968 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1969 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1970
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001971tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001972tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001973tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1974tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1975tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001976 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1977 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1978 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1979 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1980 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1981 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1982 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1983 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001984
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001985 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1986 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1987 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1988 all available space is consumed.
1989 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1990 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1991 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001992
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001993tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1994 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001995 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001996 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001997 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001998 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1999
2000tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2001 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2002 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002003 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2004 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002005
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020063.3. Debugging
2007--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002008
2009debug
2010 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2011 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2012 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2013 system startup.
2014
2015quiet
2016 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2017 line argument "-q".
2018
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002019
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020203.4. Userlists
2021--------------
2022It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2023http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2024it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2025
2026userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002027 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002028 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2029
2030group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002031 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002032 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2033 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2034
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002035user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2036 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002037 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2038 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002039 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2040 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2041 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2042 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002043
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002044 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2045 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2046 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2047 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2048 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2049 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2050 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2051 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2052 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002053
2054 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002055 userlist L1
2056 group G1 users tiger,scott
2057 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002058
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002059 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2060 user scott insecure-password elgato
2061 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002062
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002063 userlist L2
2064 group G1
2065 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002066
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002067 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2068 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2069 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002070
2071 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002072
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002073
20743.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002075----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002076It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2077several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2078instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2079values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2080automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2081In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2082using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2083tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2084reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2085Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2086that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2087each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002088
2089peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002090 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002091 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2092
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002093bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2094 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2095 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2096
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002097disabled
2098 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2099 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2100 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2101
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002102default-bind [param*]
2103 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2104
2105default-server [param*]
2106 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2107
2108 Arguments:
2109 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2110 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2111 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2112 details.
2113
2114
2115 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2116
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002117enable
2118 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2119
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002120peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002121 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2122 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2123 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2124 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2125 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2126 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2127
2128 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2129 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2130
2131 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2132 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2133 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2134 across all peers.
2135
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002136 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2137 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002138
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002139 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2140 "server" keyword explanation below).
2141
2142server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002143 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002144 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2145 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2146 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2147 of this "peers" section).
2148 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2149
2150
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002151 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002152 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002153 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002154 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2155 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2156 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002157
2158 backend mybackend
2159 mode tcp
2160 balance roundrobin
2161 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2162 stick on src
2163
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002164 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2165 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002166
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002167 Example:
2168 peers mypeers
2169 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2170 default-server ssl verify none
2171 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2172 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002173
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002174
2175table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2176 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2177
2178 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2179 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002180 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002181 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2182 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2183 "stick-table" keyword).
2184
2185 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2186 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2187 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2188 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2189 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2190 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2191 of the stick-table name as follows:
2192
2193 peers mypeers
2194 peer A ...
2195 peer B ...
2196 table t1 ...
2197
2198 frontend fe1
2199 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2200
2201 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2202 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2203
2204 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2205 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2206 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2207 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2208 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2209 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2210 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2211
2212 peers mypeers
2213 peer A ...
2214 peer B ...
2215 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2216
2217 backend t1
2218 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2219
2220 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2221 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2222 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2223
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090022243.6. Mailers
2225------------
2226It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2227If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2228in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2229
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002230mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002231 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2232 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2233
2234mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2235 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2236
2237 Example:
2238 mailers mymailers
2239 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2240 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2241
2242 backend mybackend
2243 mode tcp
2244 balance roundrobin
2245
2246 email-alert mailers mymailers
2247 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2248 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2249
2250 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2251 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2252
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002253timeout mail <time>
2254 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2255 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2256 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2257 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2258
2259 Example:
2260 mailers mymailers
2261 timeout mail 20s
2262 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002263
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020022643.7. Programs
2265-------------
2266In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2267master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2268managed the same way as the workers.
2269
2270During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2271sequence as a worker:
2272
2273 - the master is re-executed
2274 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2275 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2276 instance of the program
2277
2278During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2279
2280program <name>
2281 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2282 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2283 the management guide).
2284
2285command <command> [arguments*]
2286 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2287 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2288 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2289 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2290
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002291user <user name>
2292 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2293 See also "group".
2294
2295group <group name>
2296 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2297 See also "user".
2298
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002299option start-on-reload
2300no option start-on-reload
2301 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2302 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2303 program section.
2304
2305
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023064. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002307----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002308
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002309Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002310 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002311 - frontend <name>
2312 - backend <name>
2313 - listen <name>
2314
2315A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2316its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2317section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002318section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002319
2320A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2321connections.
2322
2323A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2324to forward incoming connections.
2325
2326A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2327parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2328
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002329All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2330'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2331case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2332
2333Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2334logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2335proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2336However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2337name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2338
2339Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2340and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002341bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002342protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2343modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2344arbitrary criteria.
2345
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002346In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2347a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002348the backend's. HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002349
2350 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2351 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2352 between responses and new requests.
2353
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002354 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2355 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2356 client-facing connection remains open.
2357
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002358 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2359 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002360
2361The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2362frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2363following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002364weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002365
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002366 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002367
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002368 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2369 ----+-----+-----+----
2370 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2371 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002372 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2373 ----+-----+-----+----
2374 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002375
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002376
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002377
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023784.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2379--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002380
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002381The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2382limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2383they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2384limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002385marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002386option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002387and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2388with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2389specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002390
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002391
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002392 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2393------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2394acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002395backlog X X X -
2396balance X - X X
2397bind - X X -
2398bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002399capture cookie - X X -
2400capture request header - X X -
2401capture response header - X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002402compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002403cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002404declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002405default-server X - X X
2406default_backend X X X -
2407description - X X X
2408disabled X X X X
2409dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002410email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002411email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002412email-alert mailers X X X X
2413email-alert myhostname X X X X
2414email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002415enabled X X X X
2416errorfile X X X X
2417errorloc X X X X
2418errorloc302 X X X X
2419-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2420errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002421force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002422filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002423fullconn X - X X
2424grace X X X X
2425hash-type X - X X
2426http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002427http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002428http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002429http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002430http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002431http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002432http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002433id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002434ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002435load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002436log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002437log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002438log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002439log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002440max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002441maxconn X X X -
2442mode X X X X
2443monitor fail - X X -
2444monitor-net X X X -
2445monitor-uri X X X -
2446option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2447option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2448option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2449option allbackups (*) X - X X
2450option checkcache (*) X - X X
2451option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2452option contstats (*) X X X -
2453option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2454option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002455-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2456option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002457option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2458option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002459option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002460option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002461option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002462option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002463option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002464option http-server-close (*) X X X X
2465option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2466option httpchk X - X X
2467option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002468option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002469option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002470option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002471option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002472option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002473option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2474option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2475option logasap (*) X X X -
2476option mysql-check X - X X
2477option nolinger (*) X X X X
2478option originalto X X X X
2479option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002480option pgsql-check X - X X
2481option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002482option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002483option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002484option smtpchk X - X X
2485option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2486option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2487option splice-request (*) X X X X
2488option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002489option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002490option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2491option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2492-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002493option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002494option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2495option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2496option tcpka X X X X
2497option tcplog X X X X
2498option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002499external-check command X - X X
2500external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002501persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2502rate-limit sessions X X X -
2503redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002504-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002505retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002506retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002507server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002508server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002509server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002510source X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002511stats admin - X X X
2512stats auth X X X X
2513stats enable X X X X
2514stats hide-version X X X X
2515stats http-request - X X X
2516stats realm X X X X
2517stats refresh X X X X
2518stats scope X X X X
2519stats show-desc X X X X
2520stats show-legends X X X X
2521stats show-node X X X X
2522stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002523-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2524stick match - - X X
2525stick on - - X X
2526stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002527stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002528stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002529tcp-check connect - - X X
2530tcp-check expect - - X X
2531tcp-check send - - X X
2532tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002533tcp-request connection - X X -
2534tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002535tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002536tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002537tcp-response content - - X X
2538tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002539timeout check X - X X
2540timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002541timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002542timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002543timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2544timeout http-request X X X X
2545timeout queue X - X X
2546timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002547timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002548timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002549timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002550transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002551unique-id-format X X X -
2552unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002553use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002554use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002555------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2556 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002557
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002558
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025594.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2560---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002561
2562This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2563
2564
2565acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2566 Declare or complete an access list.
2567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2568 no | yes | yes | yes
2569 Example:
2570 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2571 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2572 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2573
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002574 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002575
2576
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002577backlog <conns>
2578 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2579 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2580 yes | yes | yes | no
2581 Arguments :
2582 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2583 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002584 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002585
2586 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2587 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2588 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2589 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2590 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2591 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2592 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2593 backlog parameter.
2594
2595 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2596 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2597 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2598
2599 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2600
2601
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002602balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002603balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002604 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2605 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2606 yes | no | yes | yes
2607 Arguments :
2608 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2609 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2610 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2611 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2612
2613 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2614 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2615 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2616 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002617 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002618 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002619 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2620 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2621 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2622 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2623 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2624 it, so that you don't worry.
2625
2626 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2627 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2628 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2629 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2630 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2631 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2632 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2633 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002634
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002635 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2636 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2637 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2638 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2639 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2640 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2641 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2642 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2643
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002644 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002645 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002646 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2647 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002648 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002649 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2650 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2651 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2652 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2653 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002654 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2655 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2656 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2657 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2658 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2659 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002660
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002661 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2662 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2663 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2664 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2665 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2666 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2667 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2668 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002669 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002670 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002671 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2672 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2673 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002674
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002675 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2676 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2677 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2678 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2679 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2680 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2681 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2682 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2683 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2684 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2685 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2686 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002687
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002688 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002689 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2690 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2691 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2692 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2693 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2694 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2695 URIs start with a leading "/".
2696
2697 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2698 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2699 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2700 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2701
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002702 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002703 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2704
2705 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002706 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2707 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002708 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2709 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2710 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2711 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002712 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002713 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2714 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002715
2716 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2717 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2718 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2719 server will receive the request.
2720
2721 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2722 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2723 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2724 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2725 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002726 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2727 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2728 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002729
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002730 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2731 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2732 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2733 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2734 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002735
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002736 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002737 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2738 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2739 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2740
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002741 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2742 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2743 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2744
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002745 random
2746 random(<draws>)
2747 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002748 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2749 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2750 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2751 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002752 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2753 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2754 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2755 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2756 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2757 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2758 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2759 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2760 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2761 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2762 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2763 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2764 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2765 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2766 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2767 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2768 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2769 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2770 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2771 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002772
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002773 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002774 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002775 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2776 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2777 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2778 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2779 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2780 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002781 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002782 used instead.
2783
2784 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2785 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2786 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2787 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2788
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002789 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2790 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2791 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2792
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002793 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002794
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002795 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002796 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2797 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002798
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002799 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2800 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2801 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002802
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002803 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002804 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002805 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2806 NTLM relies on.
2807
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002808 Examples :
2809 balance roundrobin
2810 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002811 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002812 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2813 balance hdr(host)
2814 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002815
2816 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2817 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2818
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002819 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002820 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2821 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2822 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02002823 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002824
2825 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2826 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2827 defaults to 16 kB.
2828
2829 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2830 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2831
2832 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2833 Round Robin.
2834
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002835 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002836 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2837 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2838 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2839
2840 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2841
2842 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002843 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002844 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2845 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2846 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002847
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002848 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002849
2850
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002851bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2852bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002853 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2854 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2855 no | yes | yes | no
2856 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002857 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2858 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2859 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2860 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002861 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002862 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2863 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2864 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2865 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2866 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2867 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2868 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002869 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2870 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2871 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2872 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2873 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2874 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2875 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002876 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2877 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2878 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002879 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2880 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2881 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2882 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002883 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2884 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2885 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002886
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002887 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2888 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002889 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2890 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2891 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002892 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2893 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2894 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2895 the range.
2896
2897 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2898 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2899 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2900 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2901 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2902 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2903 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002904 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002905 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002906
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002907 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002908 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002909 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2910 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2911 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2912 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2913 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2914 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2915
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002916 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2917 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2918 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2919 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002920
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002921 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2922 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2923 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2924 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2925 in a frontend.
2926
2927 Example :
2928 listen http_proxy
2929 bind :80,:443
2930 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002931 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002932
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002933 listen http_https_proxy
2934 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002935 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002936
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002937 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2938 bind ipv6@:80
2939 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2940 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2941
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002942 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002943 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002944
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002945 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2946 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2947 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2948 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2949 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2950
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002951 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002952 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002953
2954
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002955bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002956 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2957 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2958 yes | yes | yes | yes
2959 Arguments :
2960 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2961 may be used to override a default value.
2962
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002963 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002964 option may be combined with other numbers.
2965
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002966 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002967 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2968 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2969 missing from all processes.
2970
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002971 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002972 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002973 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
2974 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
2975 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
2976 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
2977 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002978 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002979
2980 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2981 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2982 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2983 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2984 and 'even' instances.
2985
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002986 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2987 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2988 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2989 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002990
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002991 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2992 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2993
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002994 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2995 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2996 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2997
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002998 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2999 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3000
3001 Example :
3002 listen app_ip1
3003 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003004 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003005
3006 listen app_ip2
3007 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003008 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003009
3010 listen management
3011 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003012 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003013
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003014 listen management
3015 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3016 bind-process 1-4
3017
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003018 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003019
3020
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003021capture cookie <name> len <length>
3022 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3023 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3024 no | yes | yes | no
3025 Arguments :
3026 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3027 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3028 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3029 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003030 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003031
3032 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3033 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3034 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3035 right if it exceeds <length>.
3036
3037 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3038 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3039 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3040 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3041
3042 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3043 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3044 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3045
3046 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3047 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3048 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003049 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3050 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3051 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003052
3053 Example:
3054 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3055
3056 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003057 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003058
3059
3060capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003061 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003062 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3063 no | yes | yes | no
3064 Arguments :
3065 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003066 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003067 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3068 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3069 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3070
3071 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3072 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3073 it exceeds <length>.
3074
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003075 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003076 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3077 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003078 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3079 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3080 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3081 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003082 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003083 environments to find where the request came from.
3084
3085 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3086 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3087 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3088 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003089
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003090 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3091 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3092 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3093 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3094 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003095
3096 Example:
3097 capture request header Host len 15
3098 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003099 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003100
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003101 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003102 about logging.
3103
3104
3105capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003106 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003107 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3108 no | yes | yes | no
3109 Arguments :
3110 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003111 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003112 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3113 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3114 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3115
3116 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3117 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3118 it exceeds <length>.
3119
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003120 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003121 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3122 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3123 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003124 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3125 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3126 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3127 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003128
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003129 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3130 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3131 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3132 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3133 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003134
3135 Example:
3136 capture response header Content-length len 9
3137 capture response header Location len 15
3138
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003139 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003140 about logging.
3141
3142
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003143compression algo <algorithm> ...
3144compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003145compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003146 Enable HTTP compression.
3147 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3148 yes | yes | yes | yes
3149 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003150 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3151 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3152 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3153
3154 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003155 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3156 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3157 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003158
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003159 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003160 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003161
3162 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3163 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3164 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3165 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3166 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003167 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003168
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003169 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3170 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3171 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3172 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3173 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3174 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3175 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003176 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003177
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003178 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003179 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003180 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3181 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3182 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3183 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3184 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003185
3186 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3187 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3188 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3189 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3190 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003191 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3192 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3193 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3194 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3195 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003196 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3197 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003198
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003199 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003200 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3201 "Accept-Encoding" header
3202 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003203 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003204 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3205 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3206 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3207 "multipart"
3208 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3209 header
3210 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3211 and later
3212 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3213 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003214 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003215
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003216 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003217
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003218 Examples :
3219 compression algo gzip
3220 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003221
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003222
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003223cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003224 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3225 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003226 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003227 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3228 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3229 yes | no | yes | yes
3230 Arguments :
3231 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3232 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3233 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3234 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3235 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3236 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003237 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003238 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3239 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3240
3241 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3242 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3243 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3244 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3245 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3246 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003247 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3248 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003249 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003250 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3251 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003252
3253 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003254 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003255
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003256 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003257 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003258 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003259 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003260 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3261 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3262 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3263 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3264 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3265 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3266 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003267
3268 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3269 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3270 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3271 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3272 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3273 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3274 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3275 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3276 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003277 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003278 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3279 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3280 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003281
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003282 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3283 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3284 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003285 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3286 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3287 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3288 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003289 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3290 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3291 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003292
3293 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3294 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3295 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3296 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3297 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3298 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3299 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3300 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3301 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3302
3303 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3304 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3305 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3306 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3307 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3308 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3309 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3310 persistence cookie in the cache.
3311 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3312
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003313 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3314 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3315 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3316 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3317 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003318 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003319 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3320 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3321 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3322 they logout.
3323
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003324 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3325 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3326 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3327 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3328
3329 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3330 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3331 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3332 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3333 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3334 this attribute.
3335
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003336 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003337 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003338 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3339 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3340 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3341 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3342 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3343 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003344
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003345 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3346 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3347 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3348 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3349 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3350 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3351 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3352 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003353 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003354 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3355 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3356 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3357 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3358 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3359 the site.
3360
3361 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3362 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3363 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3364 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3365 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3366 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3367 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3368 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3369 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3370 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3371 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3372 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3373 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003374 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003375 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3376 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3377
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003378 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3379 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3380 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3381 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3382 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3383 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3384
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003385 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3386 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3387 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3388 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003389
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003390 Examples :
3391 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3392 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3393 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003394 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003395
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003396 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003397
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003398
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003399declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3400 Declares a capture slot.
3401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3402 no | yes | yes | no
3403 Arguments:
3404 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3405
3406 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3407 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3408 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3409 for use in the response.
3410
3411 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003412 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003413 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3414
3415
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003416default-server [param*]
3417 Change default options for a server in a backend
3418 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3419 yes | no | yes | yes
3420 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003421 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3422 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3423 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3424 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003425
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003426 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003427 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3428
3429 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003430
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003431
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003432default_backend <backend>
3433 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3434 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3435 yes | yes | yes | no
3436 Arguments :
3437 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3438
3439 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3440 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3441 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3442 will catch all undetermined requests.
3443
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003444 Example :
3445
3446 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3447 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3448 default_backend dynamic
3449
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003450 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003451
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003452
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003453description <string>
3454 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3455 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3456 no | yes | yes | yes
3457 Arguments : string
3458
3459 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3460 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3461 it describes.
3462 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3463
3464
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003465disabled
3466 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3467 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3468 yes | yes | yes | yes
3469 Arguments : none
3470
3471 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3472 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3473 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3474 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3475 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3476 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3477 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3478
3479 See also : "enabled"
3480
3481
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003482dispatch <address>:<port>
3483 Set a default server address
3484 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3485 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003486 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003487
3488 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3489 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3490 during start-up.
3491
3492 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3493 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3494 possible with normal servers.
3495
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003496 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003497 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3498 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3499 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3500 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3501
3502 See also : "server"
3503
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003504
3505dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3506 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3507 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3508 yes | no | yes | yes
3509 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3510
3511 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003512 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003513 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3514 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003515 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003516 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003517
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003518enabled
3519 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3520 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3521 yes | yes | yes | yes
3522 Arguments : none
3523
3524 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3525 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3526
3527 See also : "disabled"
3528
3529
3530errorfile <code> <file>
3531 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3532 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3533 yes | yes | yes | yes
3534 Arguments :
3535 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003536 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3537 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003538
3539 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003540 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003541 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003542 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3543 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003544
3545 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3546 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3547 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3548
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003549 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3550
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003551 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3552 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3553 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3554 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3555
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003556 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3557 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003558 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003559 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3560 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3561 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3562
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003563 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3564 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3565 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003566 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003567 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3568
3569 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3570
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003571 Example :
3572 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003573 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003574 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3575 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3576
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003577
3578errorloc <code> <url>
3579errorloc302 <code> <url>
3580 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3581 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3582 yes | yes | yes | yes
3583 Arguments :
3584 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003585 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3586 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003587
3588 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3589 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3590 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3591 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003592 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003593
3594 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3595 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3596 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3597
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003598 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3599
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003600 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3601 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3602 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3603 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003604 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003605 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3606 request.
3607
3608 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3609
3610
3611errorloc303 <code> <url>
3612 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3613 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3614 yes | yes | yes | yes
3615 Arguments :
3616 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003617 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3618 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003619
3620 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3621 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3622 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3623 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003624 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003625
3626 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3627 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3628 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3629
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003630 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3631
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003632 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3633 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3634 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3635 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003636 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003637
3638 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3639
3640
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003641email-alert from <emailaddr>
3642 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003643 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003644 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3645 yes | yes | yes | yes
3646
3647 Arguments :
3648
3649 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3650
3651 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3652 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3653
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003654 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003655 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3656 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003657
3658
3659email-alert level <level>
3660 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3661 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3662 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3663 yes | yes | yes | yes
3664
3665 Arguments :
3666
3667 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3668 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3669 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3670
3671 By default level is alert
3672
3673 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3674 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3675 for the proxy.
3676
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003677 Alerts are sent when :
3678
3679 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3680 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3681 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3682 is notice or lower
3683 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3684 and a health check status update occurs
3685
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003686 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3687 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003688 section 3.6 about mailers.
3689
3690
3691email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3692 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3693 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3694 yes | yes | yes | yes
3695
3696 Arguments :
3697
3698 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3699
3700 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3701 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3702
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003703 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3704 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003705
3706
3707email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3708 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3709 mailers.
3710 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3711 yes | yes | yes | yes
3712
3713 Arguments :
3714
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003715 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003716
3717 By default the systems hostname is used.
3718
3719 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3720 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3721 for the proxy.
3722
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003723 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3724 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003725
3726
3727email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003728 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003729 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3730 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3731 yes | yes | yes | yes
3732
3733 Arguments :
3734
3735 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3736
3737 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3738 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3739
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003740 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003741 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3742
3743
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003744force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3745 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3746 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003747 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003748
3749 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3750 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3751 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3752 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3753 marked down for maintenance operations.
3754
3755 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3756 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3757 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3758 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3759 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3760 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3761 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3762 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3763 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3764
3765 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3766 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3767 is used.
3768
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003769 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003770 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003771
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003772
3773filter <name> [param*]
3774 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3775 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3776 no | yes | yes | yes
3777 Arguments :
3778 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3779 referenced in section 9.
3780
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003781 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003782 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003783 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3784 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003785
3786 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3787 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3788
3789 Example:
3790 listen
3791 bind *:80
3792
3793 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3794 filter compression
3795 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3796
3797 compression algo gzip
3798 compression offload
3799
3800 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3801
3802 See also : section 9.
3803
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003804
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003805fullconn <conns>
3806 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3808 yes | no | yes | yes
3809 Arguments :
3810 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3811 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3812
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003813 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003814 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003815 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003816 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3817 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3818 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3819 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3820 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003821 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003822
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003823 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3824 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003825 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3826 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3827 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003828
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003829 Example :
3830 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3831 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3832 # connections.
3833 backend dynamic
3834 fullconn 10000
3835 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3836 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3837
3838 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3839
3840
3841grace <time>
3842 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3843 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003844 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003845 Arguments :
3846 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3847 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3848 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3849
3850 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3851 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003852 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003853 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3854
3855 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3856 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3857 simplify it.
3858
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003859
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003860hash-balance-factor <factor>
3861 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3862 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3863 yes | no | no | yes
3864 Arguments :
3865 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3866 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01003867 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003868
3869 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3870 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3871 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3872 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3873 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3874 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3875 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3876
3877 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3878 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3879 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3880 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3881 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3882
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003883 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
3884 consistent hashing mechanism.
3885
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003886 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3887
3888
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003889hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003890 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3891 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3892 yes | no | yes | yes
3893 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003894 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3895 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003896
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003897 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3898 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3899 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3900 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3901 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3902 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3903 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3904 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3905 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3906 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003907
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003908 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3909 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3910 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3911 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3912 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3913 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3914 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3915 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3916 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3917 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3918 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3919 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3920 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003921 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3922 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003923
3924 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3925
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003926 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003927 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3928 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3929 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003930 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3931 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3932 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003933
3934 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3935 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003936 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3937 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3938 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3939 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3940
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003941 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3942 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3943 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3944 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3945 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3946 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3947 parameter.
3948
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003949 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3950 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3951 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3952 used on strings.
3953
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003954 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3955
3956 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3957 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3958 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3959 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3960 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3961 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3962 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3963 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3964 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3965 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3966 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3967 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003968
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003969 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3970 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3971 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003972
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003973 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003974
3975
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003976http-check disable-on-404
3977 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3978 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003979 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003980 Arguments : none
3981
3982 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3983 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3984 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3985 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3986 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3987 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3988 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3989 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003990 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3991 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3992 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3993
3994 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3995
3996
3997http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003998 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003999 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004000 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004001 Arguments :
4002 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4003 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004004 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004005 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4006 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4007 details on the supported keywords.
4008
4009 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4010 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4011 with the usual backslash ('\').
4012
4013 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4014 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4015 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4016 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4017 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4018
4019 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004020 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004021 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
4022 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4023 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4024
4025 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004026 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004027 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4028 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4029 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4030 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4031
4032 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004033 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004034 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4035 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4036 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4037 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4038 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004039 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004040 trace).
4041
4042 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004043 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004044 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4045 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4046 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4047 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4048 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004049 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004050
4051 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4052 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4053 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4054 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4055 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4056 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4057 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4058 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4059
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004060 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4061 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4062 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4063
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004064 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4065 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4066
4067 Examples :
4068 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004069 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004070
4071 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004072 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004073
4074 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004075 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004076
4077 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004078 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004079
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004080 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004081
4082
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004083http-check send-state
4084 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4086 yes | no | yes | yes
4087 Arguments : none
4088
4089 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4090 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4091 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4092 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4093 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4094
4095 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4096 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4097 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4098 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4099 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004100 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4101 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4102 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4103
4104 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4105 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4106 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4107
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004108 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4109 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4110 checked in multiple backends.
4111
4112 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4113 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4114
4115 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4116 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4117 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4118 one fails.
4119
4120 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4121 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4122 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4123
4124 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4125 server's queue.
4126
4127 Example of a header received by the application server :
4128 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4129 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4130
4131 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4132
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004133
4134http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004135 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4136
4137 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4138 no | yes | yes | yes
4139
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004140 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4141 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4142 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4143 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4144 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004145
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004146 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4147 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004148
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004149 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004150
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004151 Example:
4152 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4153 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4154 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004155
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004156 http-request allow if nagios
4157 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4158 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4159 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004160
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004161 Example:
4162 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4163 acl add path /addacl
4164 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004165
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004166 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004167
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004168 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4169 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004170
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004171 Example:
4172 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4173 acl setmap path /setmap
4174 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004175
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004176 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004177
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004178 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4179 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004180
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004181 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4182 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004183
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004184http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004185
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004186 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4187 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4188 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4189 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4190 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4191 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4192 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4193 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004194
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004195http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004196
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004197 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4198 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4199 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4200 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4201 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4202 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4203 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4204 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004205
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004206http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004207
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004208 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4209 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004210
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004211
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004212http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004213
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004214 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4215 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4216 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4217 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4218 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004219
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004220 Example:
4221 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4222 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004223
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004224http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004225
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004226 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004227
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004228http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4229 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004230
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004231 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4232 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4233 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4234 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4235 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4236 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4237 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4238 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4239 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004240
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004241 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4242 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4243 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
4244 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword. If the slot
4245 <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration to prevent
4246 unexpected behavior at run time.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004247
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004248http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004249
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004250 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4251 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4252 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4253 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4254 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4255 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004256
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004257http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004258
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004259 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004260
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004261http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004262
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004263 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4264 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4265 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4266 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4267 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4268 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004269
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004270http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004271
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004272 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4273 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4274 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4275 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4276 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004277
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02004278http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4279 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
4280 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
4281 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
4282
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004283http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4284
4285 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4286 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4287 pointed by <resolvers>.
4288 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4289 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4290 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4291 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4292 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4293 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4294 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4295 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4296 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4297 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4298 to 0.0.0.0.
4299
4300 Example:
4301 resolvers mydns
4302 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4303 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4304 timeout retry 1s
4305 hold valid 10s
4306 hold nx 3s
4307 hold other 3s
4308 hold obsolete 0s
4309 accepted_payload_size 8192
4310
4311 frontend fe
4312 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4313 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4314 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4315
4316 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4317 # which mean DNS resolution error
4318 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4319
4320 default_backend be
4321
4322 backend b_503
4323 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4324 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4325 # 503 error page to end users
4326
4327 backend be
4328 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4329 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4330 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4331 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4332 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4333
4334 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4335 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4336
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004337http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4338
4339 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4340 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4341 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4342 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004343 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4344 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004345
4346 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4347
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004348http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004349
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004350 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4351 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4352 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4353 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4354 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004355
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004356http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004357
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004358 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4359 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4360 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4361 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004362
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004363http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4364 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004365
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004366 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field
4367 <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the
4368 <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and
4369 work like in <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header". The match is
4370 only case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4371 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they may
4372 contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas in
4373 their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004374
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004375 Example:
4376 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004377
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004378 # applied to:
4379 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004380
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004381 # outputs:
4382 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004383
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004384 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004385
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004386http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4387 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4388
4389 This matches the regular expression in the URI part of the request
4390 according to <match-regex>, and replaces it with the <replace-fmt>
4391 argument. Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a
4392 number are supported. The <fmt> field is interpreted as a log-format string
4393 so it may contain special expressions just like the <fmt> argument passed
4394 to "http-request set-uri". The match is exclusively case-sensitive. Any
4395 optional scheme, authority or query string are considered in the matching
4396 part of the URI. It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more
4397 expensive to evaluate than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit
4398 from a condition to avoid performing the evaluation at all if it does not
4399 match.
4400
4401 Example:
4402 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4403 http-request replace-uri (.*) /foo\1
4404
4405 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
4406 http-request replace-uri ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
4407
4408 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
4409 http-request replace-uri /foo/(.*) /\1
4410 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
4411 http-request replace-uri /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
4412
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004413http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4414 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004415
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004416 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4417 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4418 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4419 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004420
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004421 Example:
4422 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004423
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004424 # applied to:
4425 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004426
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004427 # outputs:
4428 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004429
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004430http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4431http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004432
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004433 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4434 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4435 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004436
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004437http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004438
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004439 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4440 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4441 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004442
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004443http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004444
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004445 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4446 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4447 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4448 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4449 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004450
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004451 Arguments:
4452 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4453 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004454
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004455 Example:
4456 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4457 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004458
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004459 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4460 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004461
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004462http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004463
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004464 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4465 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4466 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004467
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004468 Arguments:
4469 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4470 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004471
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004472 Example:
4473 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4474 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004475
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004476 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4477 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4478 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004479
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004480http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004481
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004482 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4483 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4484 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4485 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4486 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004487
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004488 Example:
4489 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4490 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4491 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4492 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4493 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4494 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4495 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4496 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4497 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004498
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004499http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004500
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004501 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4502 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4503 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4504 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4505 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004506
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004507http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4508 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004509
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004510 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4511 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4512 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4513 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4514 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4515 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4516 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4517 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4518 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004519
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004520http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004521
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004522 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4523 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4524 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4525 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4526 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4527 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4528 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004529
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004530http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004531
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004532 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4533 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4534 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004535
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004536http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004537
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004538 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4539 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4540 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4541 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4542 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4543 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4544 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4545 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004546
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004547http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004548
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004549 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4550 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4551 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4552 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4553 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4554 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004555
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004556 Example :
4557 # prepend the host name before the path
4558 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004559
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004560http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004561
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004562 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4563 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4564 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4565 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4566 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004567
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004568http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004569
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004570 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4571 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4572 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4573 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4574 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4575 values have higher priority.
4576 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4577 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4578 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4579 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4580 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004581
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004582http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004583
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004584 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4585 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4586 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4587 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4588 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4589 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4590 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004591
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004592 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004593
4594 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004595 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4596 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004597
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004598http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4599 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4600 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4601 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
4602 privacy.
4603
4604 Arguments :
4605 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4606 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004607
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004608 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004609 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4610 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4611
4612 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4613 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4614
4615http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4616
4617 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4618 expression.
4619
4620 Arguments:
4621 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4622 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004623
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004624 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004625 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4626 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4627
4628 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4629 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4630 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4631
4632http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4633
4634 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4635 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4636 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4637 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4638 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4639 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4640 information from the request.
4641
4642 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4643
4644http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4645
4646 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4647 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4648 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4649 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4650 path and the query string.
4651 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4652
4653http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4654
4655 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4656 inline.
4657
4658 Arguments:
4659 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4660 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4661 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4662 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4663 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4664 (request and response)
4665 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4666 processing
4667 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4668 processing
4669 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4670 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4671 and '_'.
4672
4673 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4674 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004675
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004676 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004677 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004678
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004679http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4680 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004681
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004682 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4683 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4684 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4685 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4686 agent name must be used.
4687
4688 Arguments:
4689 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4690
4691 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4692 configuration.
4693
4694http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4695
4696 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4697 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4698 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4699 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4700 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4701 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4702 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4703 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4704 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4705 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4706 action.
4707 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4708 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4709 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4710 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4711 you fully understand how it works.
4712
4713http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4714
4715 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4716 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4717 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4718 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4719 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4720 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4721 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4722 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4723 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4724 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4725 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4726 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4727 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4728
4729http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4730http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4731http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4732
4733 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4734 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4735 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4736 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4737 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4738 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4739 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4740 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4741 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4742 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4743 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4744 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4745
4746 Arguments :
4747 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4748 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4749 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4750 select which table entry to update the counters.
4751
4752 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4753 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4754 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4755 that table until the session ends.
4756
4757 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4758 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4759 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4760 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4761 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4762 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4763 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4764 useful information.
4765
4766 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4767 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4768 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4769 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4770 checks that make use of it.
4771
4772http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4773
4774 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004775
4776 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004777 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004778
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004779http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004780
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004781 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
4782 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
4783 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004784
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004785
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004786http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004787 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4788
4789 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4790 no | yes | yes | yes
4791
4792 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4793 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4794 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4795 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4796 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4797 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4798
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004799 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4800 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004801
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004802 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004803
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004804 Example:
4805 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004806
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004807 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004808
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004809 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4810 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004811
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004812 Example:
4813 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004814
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004815 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004816
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004817 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4818 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004819
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004820 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4821 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004822
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004823http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004824
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004825 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4826 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4827 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4828 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4829 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4830 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4831 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4832 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004833
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004834http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004835
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004836 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4837 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4838 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4839 example, or to pass some internal information.
4840 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4841 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4842 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004843
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004844http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004845
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004846 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4847 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004848
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004849http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004850
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004851 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004852
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004853http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004854
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004855 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
4856 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4857 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4858 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4859 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4860 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
4861 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004862
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004863 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
4864 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4865 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
4866 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4867 keyword.
4868 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration
4869 to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004870
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004871http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004872
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004873 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4874 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4875 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4876 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4877 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4878 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004879
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004880http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004881
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004882 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004883
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004884http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004885
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004886 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4887 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4888 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4889 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4890 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4891 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004892
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004893http-response deny [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004894
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004895 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
4896 and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004897
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004898http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004899
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004900 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4901 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4902 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
4903 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
4904 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
4905 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004906
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004907http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4908 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004909
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004910 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field <name>
4911 according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the <replace-fmt> argument.
4912 Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and work like in <fmt> arguments
4913 in "add-header". The match is only case-sensitive. It is important to
4914 understand that this action only considers whole header lines, regardless of
4915 the number of values they may contain. This usage is suited to headers
4916 naturally containing commas in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and
4917 so on.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004918
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004919 Example:
4920 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004921
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004922 # applied to:
4923 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004924
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004925 # outputs:
4926 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004927
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004928 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004929
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004930http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4931 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004932
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004933 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4934 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the entire
4935 header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry more than
4936 one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004937
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004938 Example:
4939 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004940
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004941 # applied to:
4942 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004943
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004944 # outputs:
4945 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004946
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004947http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4948http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004949
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004950 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4951 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4952 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004953
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004954http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004955
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004956 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4957 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4958 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004959
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004960http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004961
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004962 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4963 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4964 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4965 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4966 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004967
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004968 Arguments:
4969 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004970
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004971 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4972 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004973
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004974http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004975
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004976 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4977 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4978 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004979
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004980http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4981
4982 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4983 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4984 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4985 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
4986 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
4987
4988http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4989
4990 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4991 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4992 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4993 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4994 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
4995 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4996 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4997 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
4998 be triggered by an HTTP response.
4999
5000http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5001
5002 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5003 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5004 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5005 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5006 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5007 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5008 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5009
5010http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5011
5012 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5013 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5014 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5015 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5016 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5017 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5018 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5019 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5020
5021http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5022 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5023
5024 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5025 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5026 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5027 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005028
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005029 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005030 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5031 http-response set-status 431
5032 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5033 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005034
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005035http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005036
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005037 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5038 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5039 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5040 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5041 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5042 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5043 based on some information from the request.
5044
5045 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5046
5047http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5048
5049 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5050 inline.
5051
5052 Arguments:
5053 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5054 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5055 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5056 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5057 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5058 (request and response)
5059 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5060 processing
5061 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5062 processing
5063 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5064 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5065 and '_'.
5066
5067 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5068 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005069
5070 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005071 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005072
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005073http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005074
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005075 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5076 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5077 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5078 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5079 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5080 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5081 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5082 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5083 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5084 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5085 action.
5086 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5087 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5088 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5089 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5090 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005091
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005092http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5093http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5094http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005095
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005096 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5097 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5098 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5099 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5100 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5101 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5102
5103http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5104
5105 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5106 about <var-name>.
5107
5108 Example:
5109 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5110
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005111
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005112http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5113 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5114
5115 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5116 yes | no | yes | yes
5117
5118 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005119 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5120 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5121 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005122
5123 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5124
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005125 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5126 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5127 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5128 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5129 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5130 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5131 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5132 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5133 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5134 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005135
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005136 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5137 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5138 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5139 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5140 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5141 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5142 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5143 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005144
5145 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5146 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5147 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5148 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5149 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5150 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5151 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5152 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005153 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005154 downsides of rare connection failures.
5155
5156 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5157 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5158 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5159 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5160 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5161 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005162 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005163 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5164 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5165 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5166 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5167 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5168
5169 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005170 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5171 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5172 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005173
5174 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005175 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005176
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005177 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5178 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005179
5180 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
5181 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
5182 may not last after all sessions are closed.
5183
5184 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5185 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5186 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5187
5188 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5189
5190
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005191http-send-name-header [<header>]
5192 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
5193
5194 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5195 yes | no | yes | yes
5196
5197 Arguments :
5198
5199 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5200
5201 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005202 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005203 is added with the header string proved.
5204
5205 See also : "server"
5206
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005207id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005208 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5210 no | yes | yes | yes
5211 Arguments : none
5212
5213 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5214 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5215 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005216
5217
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005218ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5219 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5220 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005221 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005222
5223 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5224 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5225 and running).
5226
5227 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5228 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5229 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005230 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005231 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5232
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005233 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5234 "unless" condition is met.
5235
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005236 Example:
5237 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5238 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5239 ignore-persist if url_static
5240
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005241 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5242
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005243load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5244 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5245 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5246 yes | no | yes | yes
5247
5248 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5249 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5250 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005251 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005252 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5253 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5254 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5255 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5256
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005257 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005258 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005259 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005260
5261 Arguments:
5262 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5263 named "server-state-file".
5264
5265 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5266 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5267 name is used as a file name.
5268
5269 none don't load any stat for this backend
5270
5271 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005272 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5273 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5274 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005275 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005276 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005277
5278 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5279 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5280
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005281 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005282
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005283 global
5284 stats socket /tmp/socket
5285 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005286
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005287 defaults
5288 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005289
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005290 backend bk
5291 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5292 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005293
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005294
5295 Then one can run :
5296
5297 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5298
5299 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5300
5301 1
5302 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5303 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5304 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5305
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005306 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005307
5308 global
5309 stats socket /tmp/socket
5310 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5311
5312 defaults
5313 load-server-state-from-file local
5314
5315 backend bk
5316 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5317 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5318
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005319
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005320 Then one can run :
5321
5322 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5323
5324 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5325
5326 1
5327 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5328 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5329 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5330
5331 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5332 "show servers state"
5333
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005334
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005335log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005336log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
5337 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005338no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005339 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5340 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5341 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005342
5343 Prefix :
5344 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5345 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5346 prefix does not allow arguments.
5347
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005348 Arguments :
5349 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5350 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5351 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5352 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5353 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5354 parameter.
5355
5356 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5357 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5358
5359 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5360 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5361 standard syslog port).
5362
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005363 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5364 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5365 standard syslog port).
5366
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005367 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5368 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5369 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005370 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005371
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005372 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5373 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5374 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5375 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5376 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5377 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5378 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5379 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5380 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5381 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5382 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5383 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5384 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5385 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5386 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5387 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005388 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5389 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005390
5391 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5392 and "fd@2", see above.
5393
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02005394 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
5395 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
5396 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
5397 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
5398 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
5399 having the logs instantly available.
5400
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005401 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5402 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005403
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005404 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5405 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5406 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5407 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5408 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5409 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5410 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5411 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5412 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5413 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005414 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005415
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005416 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
5417 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
5418 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
5419 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
5420 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
5421
5422 <sample_size>
5423 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
5424 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
5425 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
5426 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
5427 (see also <ranges> parameter).
5428
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005429 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5430 one of the following :
5431
5432 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5433 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5434
5435 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5436 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5437
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005438 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5439 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5440 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5441 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5442 systemd logger consumes.
5443
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005444 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5445 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5446 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5447 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5448
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005449 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5450
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005451 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5452 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5453 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5454
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005455 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5456 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5457 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5458 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005459
5460 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5461 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5462 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005463 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5464 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5465 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5466 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5467 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005468
5469 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5470
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005471 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5472 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5473 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005474
5475 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5476 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5477 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5478 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5479
5480 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5481 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005482
5483 Example :
5484 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005485 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5486 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5487 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005488 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5489 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005490 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005491
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005492
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005493log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005494 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5495 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5496 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005497
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005498 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5499 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5500 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5501 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5502 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005503
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005504 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5505 "option httplog" directives.
5506
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005507log-format-sd <string>
5508 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5509 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5510 yes | yes | yes | no
5511
5512 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5513 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5514 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5515 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5516 which covers the log format string in depth.
5517
5518 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5519 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5520
5521 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5522 log format to "rfc5424".
5523
5524 Example :
5525 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5526
5527
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005528log-tag <string>
5529 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5530 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5531 yes | yes | yes | yes
5532
5533 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5534 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5535 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5536 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5537 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5538 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5539 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5540 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5541 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005542
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005543max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5544 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5545 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5546 yes | no | yes | yes
5547
5548 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5549 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5550 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5551 servers.
5552
5553 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5554 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5555 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5556 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5557 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005558 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005559 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5560 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5561 picking a different server.
5562
5563 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5564 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5565 even if they have to be queued.
5566
5567 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5568 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5569
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005570max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5571 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5572 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5573 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005574
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005575maxconn <conns>
5576 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5577 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5578 yes | yes | yes | no
5579 Arguments :
5580 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5581 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5582 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5583 closes.
5584
5585 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5586 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5587 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5588 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005589 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5590 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5591 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5592 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005593
5594 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5595 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5596 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5597
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01005598 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
5599 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005600
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005601 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5602
5603
5604mode { tcp|http|health }
5605 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5606 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5607 yes | yes | yes | yes
5608 Arguments :
5609 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5610 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5611 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5612 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5613
5614 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5615 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5616 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5617 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5618 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5619
5620 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005621 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5622 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5623 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5624 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5625 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5626 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5627 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005628
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005629 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5630 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5631 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005632
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005633 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005634 defaults http_instances
5635 mode http
5636
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005637 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005638
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005639
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005640monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005641 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005642 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5643 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005644 Arguments :
5645 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5646 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005647 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005648 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5649 backend and its backup.
5650
5651 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5652 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5653 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5654 servers in a list of backends.
5655
5656 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5657 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5658 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5659 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5660 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5661 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5662 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005663 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5664 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005665
5666 Example:
5667 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005668 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005669 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5670 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5671 monitor-uri /site_alive
5672 monitor fail if site_dead
5673
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005674 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005675
5676
5677monitor-net <source>
5678 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5679 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5680 yes | yes | yes | no
5681 Arguments :
5682 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5683 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5684 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5685 followed by a mask.
5686
5687 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5688 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005689 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005690 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5691
5692 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5693 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5694 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5695 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005696 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5697 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5698 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005699
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005700 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5701 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5702 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5703 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5704 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5705 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005706
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005707 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5708 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005709
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005710 Example :
5711 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5712 frontend www
5713 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5714
5715 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5716
5717
5718monitor-uri <uri>
5719 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5720 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5721 yes | yes | yes | no
5722 Arguments :
5723 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5724 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5725
5726 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5727 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5728 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5729 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5730 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5731 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5732 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5733 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5734
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005735 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005736 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
5737 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
5738 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
5739 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
5740 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
5741 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005742
5743 Example :
5744 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5745 frontend www
5746 mode http
5747 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5748
5749 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5750
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005751
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005752option abortonclose
5753no option abortonclose
5754 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5755 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5756 yes | no | yes | yes
5757 Arguments : none
5758
5759 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5760 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5761 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5762 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005763 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005764 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5765 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5766 encountered while delivering the response.
5767
5768 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5769 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5770 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5771 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5772 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5773 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005774 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005775 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005776 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005777 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5778 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5779 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5780
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005781 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
5782 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005783 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5784 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5785 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5786 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5787 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5788 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005789 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005790
5791 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5792 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5793
5794 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5795
5796
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005797option accept-invalid-http-request
5798no option accept-invalid-http-request
5799 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5800 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5801 yes | yes | yes | no
5802 Arguments : none
5803
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005804 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005805 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005806 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005807 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5808 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5809 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5810 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5811 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005812 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5813 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5814 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5815 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005816 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005817 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005818 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5819 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5820 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005821
5822 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5823 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5824 been confirmed.
5825
5826 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5827 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005828 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5829 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005830 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5831
5832 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5833 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5834
5835 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5836 stats socket.
5837
5838
5839option accept-invalid-http-response
5840no option accept-invalid-http-response
5841 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5842 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5843 yes | no | yes | yes
5844 Arguments : none
5845
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005846 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005847 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005848 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005849 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5850 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5851 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5852 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5853 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005854 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5855 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5856 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005857
5858 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5859 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5860 been confirmed.
5861
5862 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5863 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5864 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5865 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5866
5867 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5868 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5869
5870 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5871 stats socket.
5872
5873
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005874option allbackups
5875no option allbackups
5876 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5877 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5878 yes | no | yes | yes
5879 Arguments : none
5880
5881 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5882 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5883 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5884 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5885 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5886 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5887 order between the backup servers anymore.
5888
5889 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5890 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5891
5892 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5893 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5894
5895
5896option checkcache
5897no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005898 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005899 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5900 yes | no | yes | yes
5901 Arguments : none
5902
5903 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5904 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005905 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005906 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5907 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005908 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005909
5910 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005911 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005912 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005913 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5914 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005915 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005916 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01005917 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
5918 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005919 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01005920 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
5921 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005922 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005923 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5924 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5925 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5926 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5927 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5928 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5929 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5930 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5931 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5932
5933 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005934 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
5935 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
5936 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
5937 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005938
5939 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5940 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005941 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005942 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005943
5944 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5945 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5946
5947
5948option clitcpka
5949no option clitcpka
5950 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5952 yes | yes | yes | no
5953 Arguments : none
5954
5955 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5956 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005957 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005958 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5959
5960 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5961 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5962 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5963 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5964
5965 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5966 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5967 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5968 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5969 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5970
5971 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5972
5973 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5974 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5975 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5976
5977 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5978 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5979
5980 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5981
5982
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005983option contstats
5984 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5985 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5986 yes | yes | yes | no
5987 Arguments : none
5988
5989 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5990 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5991 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5992 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005993 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5994 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5995 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5996 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5997 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005998
5999
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006000option dontlog-normal
6001no option dontlog-normal
6002 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
6003 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6004 yes | yes | yes | no
6005 Arguments : none
6006
6007 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
6008 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
6009 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6010 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
6011 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
6012 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
6013 logged.
6014
6015 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6016 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6017 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6018
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006019 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006020 logging.
6021
6022
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006023option dontlognull
6024no option dontlognull
6025 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6026 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6027 yes | yes | yes | no
6028 Arguments : none
6029
6030 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6031 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6032 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6033 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6034 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6035 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006036 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6037 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6038 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006039
6040 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006041 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006042 would not be logged.
6043
6044 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6045 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6046
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006047 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6048 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006049
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006050
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006051option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006052 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6053 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6054 yes | yes | yes | yes
6055 Arguments :
6056 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6057 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006058 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006059 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006060
6061 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6062 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6063 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6064 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6065 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6066 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6067 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006068 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6069 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6070 possible that the client has already brought one.
6071
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006072 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006073 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006074 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006075 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006076 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006077 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006078
6079 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6080 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6081 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6082 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6083 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6084 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6085 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6086
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006087 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6088 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6089 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6090 are under the control of the end-user.
6091
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006092 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006093 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6094 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006095 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6096 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6097 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006098
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006099 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006100 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6101 frontend www
6102 mode http
6103 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6104
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006105 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6106 backend www
6107 mode http
6108 option forwardfor header X-Client
6109
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006110 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006111 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006112
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006113
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02006114option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6115no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6116 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
6117 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6118 yes | yes | yes | no
6119 Arguments : none
6120
6121 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6122 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6123 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6124 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6125 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6126 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6127 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6128
6129 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
6130 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
6131 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
6132 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6133 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
6134 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6135 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6136 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
6137 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6138 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6139
6140 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
6141
6142 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6143 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6144
6145 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
6146 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6147
6148
6149option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6150no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6151 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
6152 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6153 yes | no | yes | yes
6154 Arguments : none
6155
6156 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6157 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6158 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6159 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6160 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6161 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6162 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6163
6164 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
6165 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
6166 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
6167 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6168 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
6169 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6170 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6171 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
6172 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6173 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6174
6175 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
6176
6177 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6178 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6179
6180 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
6181 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6182
6183
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006184option http-buffer-request
6185no option http-buffer-request
6186 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6187 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6188 yes | yes | yes | yes
6189 Arguments : none
6190
6191 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6192 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6193 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6194 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6195 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6196 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
6197 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
6198 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01006199 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006200 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
6201 default.
6202
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006203 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006204
6205
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006206option http-ignore-probes
6207no option http-ignore-probes
6208 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6210 yes | yes | yes | no
6211 Arguments : none
6212
6213 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6214 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6215 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6216 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6217 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6218 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6219 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6220 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6221 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006222 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6223 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006224 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6225
6226 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6227 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6228 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6229 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6230 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6231 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6232 are often the only way to detect them.
6233
6234 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6235 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6236
6237 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6238
6239
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006240option http-keep-alive
6241no option http-keep-alive
6242 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6244 yes | yes | yes | yes
6245 Arguments : none
6246
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006247 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6248 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006249 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6250 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006251 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
6252 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
6253 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006254
6255 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6256 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006257 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6258 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6259 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6260 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6261 situations where this option may be useful :
6262
6263 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006264 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006265
6266 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6267 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6268
6269 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6270 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6271 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6272 request.
6273
6274 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6275 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006276 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6277 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6278 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006279
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006280 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6281 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6282 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6283 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6284 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6285 not set.
6286
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006287 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
6288 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
6289 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006290
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006291 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006292 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006293 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006294
6295
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006296option http-no-delay
6297no option http-no-delay
6298 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6299 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6300 yes | yes | yes | yes
6301 Arguments : none
6302
6303 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6304 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6305 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6306 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6307 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6308 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6309 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6310 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6311 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6312 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6313 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6314 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6315 affected.
6316
6317 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6318 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6319 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6320 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6321 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6322 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6323 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6324 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6325 latency environments.
6326
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006327 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6328
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006329
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006330option http-pretend-keepalive
6331no option http-pretend-keepalive
6332 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6333 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006334 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006335 Arguments : none
6336
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006337 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006338 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6339 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6340 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6341 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6342 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6343 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6344 consider the response complete.
6345
6346 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6347 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6348 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6349 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006350 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006351 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6352
6353 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6354 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6355 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6356 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6357 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6358 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6359 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6360
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006361 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6362 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6363 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6364 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6365 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6366 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006367
6368 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6369 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6370
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006371 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006372 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006373
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006374
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006375option http-server-close
6376no option http-server-close
6377 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6378 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6379 yes | yes | yes | yes
6380 Arguments : none
6381
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006382 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6383 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6384 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6385 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006386 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
6387 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
6388 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
6389 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
6390 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
6391 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
6392 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
6393 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
6394 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
6395 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
6396 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006397
6398 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6399 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6400 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6401 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006402 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6403 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006404
6405 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6406 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006407 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
6408 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
6409 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006410
6411 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6412 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6413
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006414 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6415 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006416
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006417option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006418no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006419 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6420 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6421 yes | yes | yes | no
6422 Arguments : none
6423
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006424 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006425 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6426 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6427 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6428 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6429 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6430 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6431
6432 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6433 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006434 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6435 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6436 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006437
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006438 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6439 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6440 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6441 front of an existing proxy.
6442
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006443 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6444
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006445 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006446
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006447option httpchk
6448option httpchk <uri>
6449option httpchk <method> <uri>
6450option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6451 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6452 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6453 yes | no | yes | yes
6454 Arguments :
6455 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6456 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6457 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6458 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6459 ones.
6460
6461 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6462 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6463 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6464
6465 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6466 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6467 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6468 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6469 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6470
6471 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6472 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6473 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6474 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6475 the lack of any response.
6476
6477 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6478
6479 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6480 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6481 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6482
6483 Examples :
6484 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6485 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6486 backend https_relay
6487 mode tcp
6488 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6489 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6490
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006491 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6492 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6493 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006494
6495
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006496option httpclose
6497no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006498 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006499 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6500 yes | yes | yes | yes
6501 Arguments : none
6502
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006503 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6504 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6505 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6506 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006507 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006508
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006509 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6510 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05006511 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006512 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6513 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006514
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006515 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6516 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6517 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006518
6519 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6520 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006521 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
6522 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
6523 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006524
6525 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6526 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6527
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006528 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006529
6530
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006531option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006532 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6533 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006534 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006535 Arguments :
6536 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6537 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6538 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006539 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006540 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006541
6542 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6543 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6544 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6545 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6546 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6547 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6548 ports.
6549
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006550 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6551 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006552
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006553 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6554
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006555 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006556
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006557
6558option http_proxy
6559no option http_proxy
6560 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6561 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6562 yes | yes | yes | yes
6563 Arguments : none
6564
6565 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6566 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6567 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6568 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6569 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6570
6571 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6572 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006573 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6574 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006575
6576 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6577 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6578
6579 Example :
6580 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6581 backend direct_forward
6582 option httpclose
6583 option http_proxy
6584
6585 See also : "option httpclose"
6586
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006587
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006588option independent-streams
6589no option independent-streams
6590 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006591 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6592 yes | yes | yes | yes
6593 Arguments : none
6594
6595 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6596 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6597 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6598 receive data or not.
6599
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006600 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006601 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6602 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6603 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6604 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6605 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6606 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6607 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6608 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6609 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6610 socket buffers.
6611
6612 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6613 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6614 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6615 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6616 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6617
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006618 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006619
6620
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006621option ldap-check
6622 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6623 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6624 yes | no | yes | yes
6625 Arguments : none
6626
6627 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6628 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6629 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6630 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6631
6632 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6633 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6634
6635 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6636 configure it.
6637
6638 Example :
6639 option ldap-check
6640
6641 See also : "option httpchk"
6642
6643
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006644option external-check
6645 Use external processes for server health checks
6646 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6647 yes | no | yes | yes
6648
6649 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6650 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6651 command".
6652
6653 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6654
6655 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6656
6657
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006658option log-health-checks
6659no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006660 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006661 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6662 yes | no | yes | yes
6663 Arguments : none
6664
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006665 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6666 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6667 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006668
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006669 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6670 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6671 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6672 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6673 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6674
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006675 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006676 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006677
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006678 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6679 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6680 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006681
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006682
6683option log-separate-errors
6684no option log-separate-errors
6685 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6686 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6687 yes | yes | yes | no
6688 Arguments : none
6689
6690 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6691 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6692 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6693 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6694 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6695 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6696 provides very important information.
6697
6698 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6699 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6700 error logs.
6701
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006702 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006703 logging.
6704
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006705
6706option logasap
6707no option logasap
6708 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6709 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6710 yes | yes | yes | no
6711 Arguments : none
6712
6713 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6714 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6715 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6716 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6717 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6718 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6719 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006720 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006721 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6722 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6723
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006724 Examples :
6725 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6726 mode http
6727 option httplog
6728 option logasap
6729 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6730
6731 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6732 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6733 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6734 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6735
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006736 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006737 logging.
6738
6739
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006740option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006741 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006742 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6743 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006744 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006745 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6746 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006747 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006748
6749 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6750 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006751 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006752 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6753 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6754 in the MySQL table, like this :
6755
6756 USE mysql;
6757 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6758 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6759
6760 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006761 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006762 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6763 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6764 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6765 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6766 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6767 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6768 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6769
6770 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6771 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006772
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006773 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006774
6775 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6776 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6777 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6778 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006779 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6780 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006781
6782 See also: "option httpchk"
6783
6784
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006785option nolinger
6786no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006787 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006788 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6789 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006790 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006791
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006792 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006793 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6794 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6795 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6796 connections.
6797
6798 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6799 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6800 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6801 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6802 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6803 this too.
6804
6805 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6806 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6807 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6808
6809 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6810 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6811 for servers.
6812
6813 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6814 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6815
6816
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006817option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6818 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6819 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6820 yes | yes | yes | yes
6821 Arguments :
6822 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6823 matching <network>
6824 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6825 header name.
6826
6827 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6828 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6829 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6830 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6831 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6832 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6833 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6834 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6835 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6836 possible that the client has already brought one.
6837
6838 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6839 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6840 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6841 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6842 header and requires different one.
6843
6844 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6845 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6846 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6847 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6848 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6849 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6850 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6851
6852 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6853 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6854 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6855 both are defined.
6856
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006857 Examples :
6858 # Original Destination address
6859 frontend www
6860 mode http
6861 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6862
6863 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6864 backend www
6865 mode http
6866 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6867
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006868 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006869
6870
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006871option persist
6872no option persist
6873 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6874 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6875 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006876 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006877
6878 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6879 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6880 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6881 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6882 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6883 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6884 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6885 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6886 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6887 redirected to another valid server.
6888
6889 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6890 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6891
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006892 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006893
6894
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006895option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6896 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6897 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6898 yes | no | yes | yes
6899 Arguments :
6900 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6901 PostgreSQL server.
6902
6903 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6904 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6905 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6906 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6907
6908 See also: "option httpchk"
6909
6910
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006911option prefer-last-server
6912no option prefer-last-server
6913 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6914 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6915 yes | no | yes | yes
6916 Arguments : none
6917
6918 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6919 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6920 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6921 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6922 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6923 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6924 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6925 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6926 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006927 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6928 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02006929 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
6930 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
6931 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006932 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6933 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6934 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006935
6936 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6937 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6938
6939 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6940
6941
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006942option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006943option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006944no option redispatch
6945 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6946 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6947 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006948 Arguments :
6949 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6950 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6951 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006952 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006953 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006954 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006955 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6956 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6957 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6958
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006959
6960 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6961 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6962 be able to access the service anymore.
6963
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01006964 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
6965 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006966
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006967 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006968 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6969 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006970
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006971 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6972 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6973
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006974 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006975
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006976
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006977option redis-check
6978 Use redis health checks for server testing
6979 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6980 yes | no | yes | yes
6981 Arguments : none
6982
6983 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6984 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6985 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6986 find the "+PONG" response message.
6987
6988 Example :
6989 option redis-check
6990
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006991 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006992
6993
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006994option smtpchk
6995option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6996 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6997 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6998 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006999 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007000 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007001 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007002 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
7003
7004 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
7005 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
7006 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
7007
7008 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
7009 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
7010 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
7011 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7012 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7013 dead server.
7014
7015 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7016 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007017 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007018 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7019
7020 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7021 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7022 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7023 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007024 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007025
7026 Example :
7027 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
7028
7029 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
7030
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007031
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007032option socket-stats
7033no option socket-stats
7034
7035 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7036 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7037 yes | yes | yes | no
7038
7039 Arguments : none
7040
7041
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007042option splice-auto
7043no option splice-auto
7044 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
7045 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7046 yes | yes | yes | yes
7047 Arguments : none
7048
7049 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
7050 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007051 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007052 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007053 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007054 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
7055 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7056 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7057 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7058
7059 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7060 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7061 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7062 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7063 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7064 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7065 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7066 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7067 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7068 keyword.
7069
7070 Example :
7071 option splice-auto
7072
7073 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7074 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7075
7076 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
7077 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7078
7079
7080option splice-request
7081no option splice-request
7082 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
7083 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7084 yes | yes | yes | yes
7085 Arguments : none
7086
7087 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007088 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007089 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7090 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7091 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7092 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7093
7094 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7095
7096 Example :
7097 option splice-request
7098
7099 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7100 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7101
7102 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7103 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7104
7105
7106option splice-response
7107no option splice-response
7108 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7109 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7110 yes | yes | yes | yes
7111 Arguments : none
7112
7113 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007114 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007115 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7116 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7117 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7118 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7119
7120 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7121
7122 Example :
7123 option splice-response
7124
7125 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7126 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7127
7128 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7129 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7130
7131
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007132option spop-check
7133 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7135 no | no | no | yes
7136 Arguments : none
7137
7138 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7139 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7140 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7141 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7142
7143 Example :
7144 option spop-check
7145
7146 See also : "option httpchk"
7147
7148
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007149option srvtcpka
7150no option srvtcpka
7151 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7152 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7153 yes | no | yes | yes
7154 Arguments : none
7155
7156 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7157 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007158 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007159 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7160
7161 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7162 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7163 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7164 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7165
7166 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7167 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7168 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7169 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7170 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7171
7172 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7173
7174 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7175 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7176 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7177
7178 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7179 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7180
7181 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7182
7183
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007184option ssl-hello-chk
7185 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7187 yes | no | yes | yes
7188 Arguments : none
7189
7190 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7191 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7192 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7193 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7194 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7195 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7196 hello message.
7197
7198 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7199 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7200 messages, which is appreciable.
7201
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007202 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7203 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7204 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007205
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007206 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7207
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007208
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007209option tcp-check
7210 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7211 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7212 yes | no | yes | yes
7213
7214 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7215 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7216
7217 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7218 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7219 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7220
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007221 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007222 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7223 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7224 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7225 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7226 only.
7227
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007228 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007229 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7230 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7231 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7232 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7233
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007234 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007235 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7236 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007237 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007238 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7239 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7240 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7241 the respective protocols.
7242 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007243 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007244
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007245 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7246 script.
7247
7248 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7249 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7250 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7251 The "comment" is of course optional.
7252
7253
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007254 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007255 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007256 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007257 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007258
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007259 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007260 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007261 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007262
7263 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7264 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007265 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007266 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007267 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007268 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007269 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007270 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007271 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7272 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007273 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007274 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7275 tcp-check expect string +OK
7276
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007277 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007278 (send many headers before analyzing)
7279 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007280 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007281 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7282 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7283 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7284 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007285 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007286
7287
7288 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7289
7290
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007291option tcp-smart-accept
7292no option tcp-smart-accept
7293 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7294 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7295 yes | yes | yes | no
7296 Arguments : none
7297
7298 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7299 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7300 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7301 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7302 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7303 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7304
7305 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7306 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7307 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7308 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7309
7310 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7311 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7312 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007313 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007314
7315 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7316 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7317 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7318
7319 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7320 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7321 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7322
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007323 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7324
7325
7326option tcp-smart-connect
7327no option tcp-smart-connect
7328 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7329 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7330 yes | no | yes | yes
7331 Arguments : none
7332
7333 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7334 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7335 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7336 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7337 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7338
7339 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7340 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7341 complex.
7342
7343 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7344 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7345 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7346
7347 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7348 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7349
7350 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7351
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007352
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007353option tcpka
7354 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7356 yes | yes | yes | yes
7357 Arguments : none
7358
7359 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7360 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007361 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007362 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7363
7364 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7365 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7366 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7367 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7368
7369 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7370 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7371 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7372 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7373 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7374
7375 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7376
7377 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7378 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7379 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7380 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7381 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7382 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7383 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7384 backends.
7385
7386 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7387
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007388
7389option tcplog
7390 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007392 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007393 Arguments : none
7394
7395 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7396 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7397 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7398 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7399 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7400 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7401 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7402 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7403
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007404 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7405
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007406 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007407
7408
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007409option transparent
7410no option transparent
7411 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7412 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007413 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007414 Arguments : none
7415
7416 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7417 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7418 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7419 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7420 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7421 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7422 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7423 appropriate server.
7424
7425 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7426 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7427
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007428 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007429 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007430
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007431
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007432external-check command <command>
7433 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7434 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7435 yes | no | yes | yes
7436
7437 Arguments :
7438 <command> is the external command to run
7439
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007440 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7441
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007442 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007443
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007444 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7445 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7446 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7447 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7448 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7449 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007450
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007451 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7452
7453 Environment variables :
7454 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7455 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7456
7457 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7458
7459 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7460
7461 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7462 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7463 for a UNIX socket).
7464
7465 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7466
7467 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7468
7469 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7470
7471 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7472
7473 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7474
7475 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7476 socket).
7477
7478 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7479 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7480
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02007481 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
7482
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007483 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7484 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7485 failed.
7486
7487 Example :
7488 external-check command /bin/true
7489
7490 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7491
7492
7493external-check path <path>
7494 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7495 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7496 yes | no | yes | yes
7497
7498 Arguments :
7499 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7500
7501 The default path is "".
7502
7503 Example :
7504 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7505
7506 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7507 "external-check command"
7508
7509
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007510persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007511persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007512 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7513 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7514 yes | no | yes | yes
7515 Arguments :
7516 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007517 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7518 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007519
7520 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7521 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007522 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007523 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7524 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7525 forwarded to this server.
7526
7527 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7528 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7529 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007530 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007531 a single "listen" section.
7532
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007533 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7534 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7535 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7536
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007537 Example :
7538 listen tse-farm
7539 bind :3389
7540 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7541 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7542 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7543 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7544 persist rdp-cookie
7545 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007546 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007547 balance rdp-cookie
7548 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7549 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7550
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007551 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7552 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007553
7554
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007555rate-limit sessions <rate>
7556 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7557 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7558 yes | yes | yes | no
7559 Arguments :
7560 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7561 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7562
7563 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7564 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7565 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7566 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7567 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7568 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7569
7570 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7571 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7572 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7573 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7574
7575 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7576 listen smtp
7577 mode tcp
7578 bind :25
7579 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007580 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007581
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007582 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7583 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7584 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007585
7586 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7587
7588
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007589redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7590redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7591redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007592 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7593 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7594 no | yes | yes | yes
7595
7596 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007597 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007598
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007599 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007600 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007601 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7602 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7603 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007604
7605 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7606 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7607 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7608 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7609 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007610 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7611 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7612 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7613 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007614
7615 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7616 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7617 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7618 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7619 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7620 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007621 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007622 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007623 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7624 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7625 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007626
7627 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007628 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7629 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7630 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007631 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007632 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7633 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7634 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7635 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007636
7637 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007638 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007639
7640 - "drop-query"
7641 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7642 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7643 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7644 with a location-type redirect.
7645
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007646 - "append-slash"
7647 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7648 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7649 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7650 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7651
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007652 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7653 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7654 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7655 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7656 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7657 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7658 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7659
7660 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7661 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7662 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7663 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7664 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7665 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7666 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007667
7668 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7669 acl clear dst_port 80
7670 acl secure dst_port 8080
7671 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007672 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007673 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007674 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7675
7676 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007677 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7678 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7679 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007680 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007681
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007682 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7683 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7684 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7685
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007686 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007687 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007688
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007689 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007690 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7691 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7692 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007693
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007694 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007695
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007696
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007697retries <value>
7698 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7699 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7700 yes | no | yes | yes
7701 Arguments :
7702 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7703 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7704 default value is 3.
7705
7706 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7707 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7708 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7709
7710 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007711 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7712 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007713
7714 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7715 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7716
7717 See also : "option redispatch"
7718
7719
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007720retry-on [list of keywords]
7721 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
7722 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7723 yes | no | yes | yes
7724 Arguments :
7725 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
7726 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
7727 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
7728 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
7729
7730 none never retry
7731
7732 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
7733 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
7734
7735 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
7736 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
7737 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
7738 request timeout on the server side, poor network
7739 condition, or a server crash or restart while
7740 processing the request.
7741
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02007742 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
7743 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
7744 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
7745 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
7746 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
7747 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
7748 overflow attack for example).
7749
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007750 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
7751 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
7752 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
7753 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
7754 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
7755 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
7756 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
7757 amplify denial of service attacks.
7758
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02007759 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
7760 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
7761 considered to be safe to retry.
7762
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007763 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
7764 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
7765 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
7766 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
7767
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02007768 all-retryable-errors
7769 retry request for any error that are considered
7770 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
7771 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
7772 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
7773
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007774 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
7775 not cumulative.
7776
7777 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
7778 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
7779 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
7780 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
7781
7782 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
7783 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
7784 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
7785 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
7786 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
7787 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
7788 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
7789 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
7790 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
7791 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
7792 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
7793 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
7794
7795 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
7796 should not use this directive.
7797
7798 The default is "conn-failure".
7799
7800 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
7801
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007802server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007803 Declare a server in a backend
7804 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7805 no | no | yes | yes
7806 Arguments :
7807 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007808 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007809 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007810
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007811 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7812 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7813 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7814 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007815 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7816 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7817 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7818 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7819 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007820 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7821 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7822 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7823 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7824 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7825 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7826 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007827 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02007828 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
7829 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
7830 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
7831 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
7832 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
7833 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007834 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7835 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01007836 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
7837 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007838
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007839 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007840 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7841 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7842 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7843 adding this value to the client's port.
7844
7845 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7846 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007847 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007848
7849 Examples :
7850 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7851 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007852 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007853 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7854 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7855 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007856
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007857 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7858 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7859 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7860 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7861 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7862
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007863 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7864 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007865
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007866server-state-file-name [<file>]
7867 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7868 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7869 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7870 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7871 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7872 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7873
7874 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7875 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7876
7877 global
7878 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7879
7880 backend bk
7881 load-server-state-from-file
7882
7883 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7884 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007885
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02007886server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
7887 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
7888 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
7889 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7890 no | no | yes | yes
7891
7892 Arguments:
7893 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
7894
7895 <num | range>
7896 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
7897 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
7898 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
7899 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
7900
7901 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
7902
7903 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
7904
7905 <params*>
7906 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
7907 keyword.
7908
7909 Examples:
7910 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
7911 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
7912 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
7913
7914 # or
7915 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
7916
7917 # would be equivalent to:
7918 server srv1 google.com:80 check
7919 server srv2 google.com:80 check
7920 server srv3 google.com:80 check
7921
7922
7923
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007924source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007925source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007926source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007927 Set the source address for outgoing connections
7928 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7929 yes | no | yes | yes
7930 Arguments :
7931 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
7932 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007933
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007934 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007935 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
7936 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
7937 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
7938 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
7939 supported prefixes are :
7940 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7941 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7942 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007943 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02007944 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7945 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007946
7947 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
7948 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007949 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
7950 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
7951 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007952
7953 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
7954 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
7955 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
7956 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
7957 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
7958 <addr>.
7959
7960 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
7961 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
7962 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
7963 port.
7964
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007965 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
7966 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
7967 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
7968 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01007969 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007970 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
7971 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
7972 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
7973 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
7974 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
7975 HTTP header.
7976
7977 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
7978 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007979 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007980 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
7981 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
7982 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
7983 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
7984 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
7985 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
7986 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
7987
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007988 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
7989 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
7990 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
7991 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
7992 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
7993 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
7994
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007995 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
7996 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
7997 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
7998 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
7999
8000 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8001 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8002 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8003 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8004 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8005 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8006
8007 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8008 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8009 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8010 there are two methods :
8011
8012 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8013 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8014 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8015 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8016 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8017 of the client ranges may be used.
8018
8019 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8020 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8021 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8022 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8023 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8024 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8025 same session.
8026
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008027 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8028 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8029 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008030 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008031
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008032 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8033
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008034 Examples :
8035 backend private
8036 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8037 source 192.168.1.200
8038
8039 backend transparent_ssl1
8040 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8041 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8042
8043 backend transparent_ssl2
8044 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8045 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8046 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8047
8048 backend transparent_ssl3
8049 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8050 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8051 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8052
8053 backend transparent_smtp
8054 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8055 # with Tproxy version 4.
8056 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8057
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008058 backend transparent_http
8059 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8060 # proxy.
8061 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8062
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008063 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008064 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8065
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008066
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008067stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8068 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8069 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008070 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008071
8072 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8073 matched.
8074
8075 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8076 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8077
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008078 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8079 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008080 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008081
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008082 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8083 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8084 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8085 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008086
8087 Example :
8088 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8089 backend stats_localhost
8090 stats enable
8091 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8092
8093 Example :
8094 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8095 backend stats_auth
8096 stats enable
8097 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8098 stats admin if TRUE
8099
8100 Example :
8101 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8102 userlist stats-auth
8103 group admin users admin
8104 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8105 group readonly users haproxy
8106 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8107
8108 backend stats_auth
8109 stats enable
8110 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8111 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8112 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8113 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8114
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008115 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8116 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8117 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008118
8119
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008120stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8121 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8122 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008123 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008124 Arguments :
8125 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8126
8127 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8128
8129 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8130 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8131 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8132 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8133 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8134 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8135
8136 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8137 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8138 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008139 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008140
8141 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8142 report using "stats scope".
8143
8144 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8145 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8146 unobvious parameters.
8147
8148 Example :
8149 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8150 backend public_www
8151 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8152 stats enable
8153 stats hide-version
8154 stats scope .
8155 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008156 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008157 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8158 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8159
8160 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8161 backend private_monitoring
8162 stats enable
8163 stats uri /admin?stats
8164 stats refresh 5s
8165
8166 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8167
8168
8169stats enable
8170 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8171 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008172 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008173 Arguments : none
8174
8175 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8176 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8177 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8178 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8179 - stats auth : no authentication
8180 - stats scope : no restriction
8181
8182 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8183 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8184 unobvious parameters.
8185
8186 Example :
8187 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8188 backend public_www
8189 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8190 stats enable
8191 stats hide-version
8192 stats scope .
8193 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008194 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008195 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8196 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8197
8198 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8199 backend private_monitoring
8200 stats enable
8201 stats uri /admin?stats
8202 stats refresh 5s
8203
8204 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8205
8206
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008207stats hide-version
8208 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008210 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008211 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008212
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008213 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8214 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8215 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8216 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8217 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8218 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008219
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008220 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8221 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8222 unobvious parameters.
8223
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008224 Example :
8225 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8226 backend public_www
8227 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008228 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008229 stats hide-version
8230 stats scope .
8231 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008232 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008233 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8234 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008235
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008236 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8237 backend private_monitoring
8238 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008239 stats uri /admin?stats
8240 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008241
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008242 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008243
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008244
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008245stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8246 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8247 Access control for statistics
8248
8249 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8250 no | no | yes | yes
8251
8252 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8253 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8254 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8255 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8256 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8257 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8258
8259 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8260 instance.
8261
8262 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8263 about ACL usage.
8264
8265
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008266stats realm <realm>
8267 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8268 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008269 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008270 Arguments :
8271 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8272 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8273 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8274
8275 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8276 using a backslash ('\').
8277
8278 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8279 only related to authentication.
8280
8281 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8282 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8283 unobvious parameters.
8284
8285 Example :
8286 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8287 backend public_www
8288 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8289 stats enable
8290 stats hide-version
8291 stats scope .
8292 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008293 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008294 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8295 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8296
8297 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8298 backend private_monitoring
8299 stats enable
8300 stats uri /admin?stats
8301 stats refresh 5s
8302
8303 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8304
8305
8306stats refresh <delay>
8307 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8308 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008309 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008310 Arguments :
8311 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8312 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8313 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8314 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8315 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8316 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8317
8318 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8319 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8320 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8321 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8322
8323 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8324 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8325 unobvious parameters.
8326
8327 Example :
8328 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8329 backend public_www
8330 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8331 stats enable
8332 stats hide-version
8333 stats scope .
8334 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008335 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008336 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8337 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8338
8339 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8340 backend private_monitoring
8341 stats enable
8342 stats uri /admin?stats
8343 stats refresh 5s
8344
8345 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8346
8347
8348stats scope { <name> | "." }
8349 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8350 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008351 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008352 Arguments :
8353 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8354 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8355 section in which the statement appears.
8356
8357 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8358 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8359 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8360 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8361 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8362 exists.
8363
8364 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8365 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8366 unobvious parameters.
8367
8368 Example :
8369 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8370 backend public_www
8371 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8372 stats enable
8373 stats hide-version
8374 stats scope .
8375 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008376 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008377 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8378 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8379
8380 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8381 backend private_monitoring
8382 stats enable
8383 stats uri /admin?stats
8384 stats refresh 5s
8385
8386 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8387
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008388
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008389stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008390 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008392 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008393
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008394 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008395 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8396
8397 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8398 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8399
8400 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8401 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008402 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008403
8404 Example :
8405 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8406 backend private_monitoring
8407 stats enable
8408 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8409 stats uri /admin?stats
8410 stats refresh 5s
8411
8412 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8413 global section.
8414
8415
8416stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008417 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8418 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8419 yes | yes | yes | yes
8420 Arguments : none
8421
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008422 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008423 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8424 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8425 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8426 - IP (socket, server)
8427 - cookie (backend, server)
8428
8429 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8430 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008431 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008432
8433 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8434
8435
8436stats show-node [ <name> ]
8437 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8438 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008439 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008440 Arguments:
8441 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8442 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8443
8444 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8445 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008446 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008447
8448 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8449 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8450 unobvious parameters.
8451
8452 Example:
8453 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8454 backend private_monitoring
8455 stats enable
8456 stats show-node Europe-1
8457 stats uri /admin?stats
8458 stats refresh 5s
8459
8460 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8461 section.
8462
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008463
8464stats uri <prefix>
8465 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8466 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008467 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008468 Arguments :
8469 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8470 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8471 query string.
8472
8473 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8474 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8475 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8476 possible to reach it in the application.
8477
8478 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008479 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008480 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8481 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8482 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8483 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8484
8485 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8486 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8487 an address or a port to statistics only.
8488
8489 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8490 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8491 unobvious parameters.
8492
8493 Example :
8494 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8495 backend public_www
8496 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8497 stats enable
8498 stats hide-version
8499 stats scope .
8500 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008501 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008502 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8503 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8504
8505 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8506 backend private_monitoring
8507 stats enable
8508 stats uri /admin?stats
8509 stats refresh 5s
8510
8511 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8512
8513
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008514stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8515 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008516 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008517 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008518
8519 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008520 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008521 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008522 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008523 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8524
8525 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8526 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8527 the "stick-table" statement.
8528
8529 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8530 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8531 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8532 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8533 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8534
8535 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8536 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8537 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8538 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8539 transformation rules.
8540
8541 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8542 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8543 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8544 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8545 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8546 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8547 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8548
8549 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8550 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8551 ACL based conditions.
8552
8553 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8554 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8555 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8556 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8557
8558 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8559 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8560 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8561 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8562
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008563 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8564 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008565 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008566
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008567 Example :
8568 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8569 # last 30 minutes
8570 backend pop
8571 mode tcp
8572 balance roundrobin
8573 stick store-request src
8574 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8575 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8576 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8577
8578 backend smtp
8579 mode tcp
8580 balance roundrobin
8581 stick match src table pop
8582 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8583 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8584
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008585 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008586 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008587
8588
8589stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8590 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8591 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8592 no | no | yes | yes
8593
8594 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8595 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8596 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8597 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8598
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008599 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8600 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008601 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008602
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008603 Examples :
8604 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008605 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008606
8607 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8608 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8609 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8610
8611
8612 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8613 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8614 backend http
8615 mode http
8616 balance roundrobin
8617 stick on src table https
8618 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8619 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8620 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8621
8622 backend https
8623 mode tcp
8624 balance roundrobin
8625 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8626 stick on src
8627 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8628 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8629
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008630 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008631
8632
8633stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8634 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8635 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8636 no | no | yes | yes
8637
8638 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008639 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008640 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008641 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008642 server is selected.
8643
8644 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8645 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8646 the "stick-table" statement.
8647
8648 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8649 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8650 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8651 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8652 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8653 address.
8654
8655 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8656 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8657 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8658 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8659 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8660 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8661 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8662 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8663 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8664 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8665
8666 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8667 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8668 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8669 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8670 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8671 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8672 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8673
8674 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8675 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8676 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8677 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8678
8679 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8680 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8681 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8682 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8683 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8684 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008685 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8686 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8687 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8688 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8689 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8690 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008691
8692 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8693 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8694 the request.
8695
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008696 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8697 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008698 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008699
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008700 Example :
8701 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8702 # last 30 minutes
8703 backend pop
8704 mode tcp
8705 balance roundrobin
8706 stick store-request src
8707 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8708 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8709 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8710
8711 backend smtp
8712 mode tcp
8713 balance roundrobin
8714 stick match src table pop
8715 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8716 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8717
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008718 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008719 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008720
8721
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008722stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008723 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8724 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008725 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008726 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008727 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008728
8729 Arguments :
8730 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8731 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8732 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8733 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8734
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008735 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8736 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8737 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8738 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8739
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008740 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8741 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8742 instance.
8743
8744 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8745 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8746 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8747 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8748 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8749 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008750 to 32 characters.
8751
8752 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8753 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8754 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008755 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008756 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8757 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008758
8759 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008760 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8761 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008762 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8763 increase.
8764
8765 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008766 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8767 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8768 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008769
8770 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8771 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8772 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8773 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008774 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008775 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8776 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8777 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8778 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8779 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8780 parameter (see below).
8781
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008782 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8783 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8784 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8785 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8786 soft restart.
8787
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008788 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8789 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008790
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008791 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8792 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8793 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8794 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008795 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008796 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008797 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8798 if not expiration delay is specified.
8799
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008800 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8801 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8802 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8803 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008804 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8805 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8806 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8807 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8808 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8809 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8810 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8811 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8812 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8813 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8814 types and their arguments.
8815
8816 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8817 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8818 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8819 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8820
8821 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8822 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8823 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008824 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008825
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008826 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8827 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8828 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008829 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008830 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008831 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008832
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01008833 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8834 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8835 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8836 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
8837
8838 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
8839 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8840 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8841 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8842 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8843 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
8844
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008845 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8846 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8847 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8848 they were received.
8849
8850 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8851 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8852 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8853 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8854 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8855
8856 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8857 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8858 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8859 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8860 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8861
8862 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8863 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8864 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8865
8866 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8867 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8868 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8869 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
8870 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8871
8872 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8873 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
8874 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
8875 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
8876 the client side.
8877
8878 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8879 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8880 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8881 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
8882 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
8883 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
8884 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
8885
8886 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8887 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
8888 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
8889 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
8890 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
8891 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008892 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008893
8894 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8895 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8896 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8897 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
8898 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
8899 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8900
8901 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008902 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008903 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
8904 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
8905
8906 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8907 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8908 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8909 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8910 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8911 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
8912 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
8913 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
8914 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
8915 recommended for better fairness.
8916
8917 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008918 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008919 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
8920 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
8921
8922 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
8923 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8924 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8925 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8926 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8927 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
8928 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
8929 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
8930 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
8931 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008932
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008933 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
8934 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008935 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
8936 reference it.
8937
8938 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
8939 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01008940 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
8941 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
8942 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008943
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008944 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
8945 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
8946 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
8947 something that can be ignored.
8948
8949 Example:
8950 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
8951 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
8952 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
8953 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
8954
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008955 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01008956 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008957
8958
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008959stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01008960 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008961 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8962 no | no | yes | yes
8963
8964 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008965 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008966 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008967 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008968 server is selected.
8969
8970 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8971 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8972 the "stick-table" statement.
8973
8974 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8975 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8976 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
8977 when the response is a SSL server hello.
8978
8979 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8980 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
8981 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
8982 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
8983 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
8984 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008985 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008986 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
8987 rules.
8988
8989 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8990 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8991 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8992 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8993 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8994 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8995 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8996
8997 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
8998 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8999 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9000 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9001
9002 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9003 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9004 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9005 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9006 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9007 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009008 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9009 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9010 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9011 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9012 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9013 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9014 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9015 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9016 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009017
9018 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9019
9020 Example :
9021 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9022 backend https
9023 mode tcp
9024 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009025 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009026 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009027
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009028 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9029 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9030
9031 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9032 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9033 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9034
9035 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9036 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009037
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009038 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9039 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9040 # at offset 44.
9041
9042 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9043 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9044
9045 # Learn on response if server hello.
9046 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009047
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009048 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9049 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9050
9051 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9052 extraction.
9053
9054
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009055tcp-check connect [params*]
9056 Opens a new connection
9057 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9058 no | no | yes | yes
9059
9060 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9061 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9062 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9063
9064 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9065 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9066 of the sequence.
9067
9068 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9069 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9070 do.
9071
9072 Parameters :
9073 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9074 use the TCP connection.
9075
9076 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9077 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9078 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9079
9080 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9081
9082 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9083
9084 Examples:
9085 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9086 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9087 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9088 option tcp-check
9089 tcp-check connect
9090 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9091 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9092 tcp-check send \r\n
9093 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9094 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9095 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9096 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9097 tcp-check send \r\n
9098 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9099 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9100
9101 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9102 option tcp-check
9103 tcp-check connect port 110
9104 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9105 tcp-check connect port 143
9106 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9107 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9108
9109 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9110
9111
9112tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009113 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009114 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9115 no | no | yes | yes
9116
9117 Arguments :
9118 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9119 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9120 binary.
9121 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9122 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9123 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9124
9125 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9126 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9127 with the usual backslash ('\').
9128 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009129 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009130 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9131 used upper or lower case.
9132
9133
9134 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9135
9136 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9137 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9138 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9139 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9140 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9141 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9142 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9143 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9144
9145 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9146 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9147 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9148 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9149 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9150 expression.
9151
9152 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9153 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9154 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9155 this exact hexadecimal string.
9156 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9157
9158 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9159 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9160 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9161 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9162 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9163 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9164 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9165 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9166 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9167 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9168 the null character.
9169
9170 Examples :
9171 # perform a POP check
9172 option tcp-check
9173 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9174
9175 # perform an IMAP check
9176 option tcp-check
9177 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9178
9179 # look for the redis master server
9180 option tcp-check
9181 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009182 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009183 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9184 tcp-check expect string role:master
9185 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9186 tcp-check expect string +OK
9187
9188
9189 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9190 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9191
9192
9193tcp-check send <data>
9194 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9195 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9196 no | no | yes | yes
9197
9198 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9199 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9200
9201 Examples :
9202 # look for the redis master server
9203 option tcp-check
9204 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9205 tcp-check expect string role:master
9206
9207 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9208 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9209
9210
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009211tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9212 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009213 tcp health check
9214 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9215 no | no | yes | yes
9216
9217 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9218 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009219 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009220 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9221 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9222 hexadecimal string.
9223 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9224
9225 Examples :
9226 # redis check in binary
9227 option tcp-check
9228 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9229 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9230
9231
9232 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9233 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9234
9235
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009236tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9237 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009238 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9239 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009240 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009241 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9242 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009243
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009244 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009245
9246 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9247 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009248 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9249 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9250 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9251 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9252 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9253 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009254
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009255 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9256 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9257 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9258 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009259
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009260 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009261 - accept :
9262 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9263 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9264 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009265
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009266 - reject :
9267 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9268 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9269 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9270 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9271 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9272 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9273 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9274 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9275 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9276 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9277 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009278 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009279
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009280 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9281 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9282 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9283 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9284 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9285 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9286 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9287 hosts.
9288
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009289 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9290 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9291 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9292 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9293 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9294 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9295 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9296 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9297
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009298 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9299 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9300 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9301 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9302 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9303 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9304 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9305 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9306 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009307 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9308 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009309
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009310 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009311 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009312 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
9313 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
9314 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05009315 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009316 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
9317 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
9318 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9319 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
9320 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
9321 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
9322 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
9323 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009324
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009325 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009326 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009327 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009328 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009329 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9330 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9331 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009332
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009333 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9334 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9335 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9336 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009337
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009338 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9339 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9340 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9341 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9342 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009343 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9344 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9345 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9346 layer7 information is extracted.
9347
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009348 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9349 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9350 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9351 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9352 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009353
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009354 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9355 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9356 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9357 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9358
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009359 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9360 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9361 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9362 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9363
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009364 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
9365 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9366 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9367 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9368 continues.
9369
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009370 - set-src <expr> :
9371 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9372 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9373 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009374 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009375
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009376 Arguments:
9377 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9378 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009379
9380 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009381 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9382
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009383 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9384 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009385
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009386 - set-src-port <expr> :
9387 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9388 expression.
9389
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009390 Arguments:
9391 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9392 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009393
9394 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009395 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9396
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009397 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9398 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9399 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009400
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009401 - set-dst <expr> :
9402 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9403 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9404 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9405 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9406 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9407
9408 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9409 followed by some converters.
9410
9411 Example:
9412
9413 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9414 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9415
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009416 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9417 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9418
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009419 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9420 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9421 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9422 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9423
9424
9425 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9426 followed by some converters.
9427
9428 Example:
9429
9430 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9431
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009432 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9433 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9434 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9435
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009436 - "silent-drop" :
9437 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009438 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009439 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9440 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9441 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9442 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9443 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009444 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9445 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009446 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9447 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009448 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009449 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9450 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9451 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9452 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9453
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009454 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9455 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9456 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009457
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009458 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9459 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9460 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009461
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009462 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009463 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009464 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009465
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009466 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9467 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9468 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009469
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009470 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009471 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9472 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009473
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009474 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9475
9476 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9477
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009478 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9479
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009480 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009481
9482
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009483tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9484 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009485 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009486 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009487 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009488 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9489 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009490
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009491 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009492
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009493 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009494 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9495 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9496 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9497 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009498
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009499 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9500 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9501 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9502 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009503 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9504 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9505 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9506 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9507 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9508 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009509 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009510 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009511
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009512 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9513 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9514 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9515 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009516
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009517 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009518 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01009519 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009520 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9521 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009522 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009523 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009524 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009525 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009526 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +02009527 - set-dst <expr>
9528 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009529 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009530 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009531 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009532 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009533
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009534 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9535 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01009536 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
9537 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009538
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009539 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9540 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9541 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9542 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9543 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9544 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009545
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009546 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009547 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9548 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009549
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009550 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009551 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9552 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9553 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9554 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009555 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9556 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9557 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009558
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009559 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009560 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9561 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9562 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009563
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +02009564 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
9565 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
9566
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009567 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009568 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9569 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009570
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009571 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9572 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009573 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009574 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9575 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009576 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009577 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009578 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009579 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9580 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009581 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009582 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9583 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009584
9585 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9586 followed by some converters.
9587
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009588 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9589 <var-name>.
9590
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009591 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
9592 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
9593 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
9594 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
9595 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
9596
9597 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
9598 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
9599 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
9600 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
9601 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
9602 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
9603 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
9604 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
9605 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
9606 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
9607 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
9608
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009609 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9610 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9611 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9612 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9613 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9614
9615 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9616
9617 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9618
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009619 Example:
9620
9621 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009622 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009623
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009624 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009625 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9626 # and reject everything else.
9627 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9628 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009629 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009630 tcp-request content reject
9631
9632 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009633 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9634 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9635 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009636 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009637
9638 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9639 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9640 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009641 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009642 tcp-request content reject
9643
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009644 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009645 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009646 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009647 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009648 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9649 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009650
9651 Example:
9652 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9653 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009654 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009655
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009656 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009657 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009658
9659 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009660 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009661 # protecting all our sites
9662 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009663 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9664 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009665 ...
9666 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9667
9668 backend http_dynamic
9669 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009670 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009671 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009672 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009673 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009674 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009675 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009676
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009677 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009678
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03009679 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
9680 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009681
9682
9683tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9684 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9685 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009686 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009687 Arguments :
9688 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9689 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9690 as explained at the top of this document.
9691
9692 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9693 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9694 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9695 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9696 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9697
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009698 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9699 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9700 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9701 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9702
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009703 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9704 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009705 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009706 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009707 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9708 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9709 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9710 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009711
9712 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9713 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9714 it pass through unaffected.
9715
9716 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9717 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9718 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009719 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009720 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9721 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009722 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9723 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9724 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009725
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009726 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009727 "timeout client".
9728
9729
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009730tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9731 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9732 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9733 no | no | yes | yes
9734 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009735 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9736 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009737
9738 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9739
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009740 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009741 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9742 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009743 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9744 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009745
9746 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9747
9748 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9749 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9750 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9751 inserted.
9752
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009753 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009754 - accept :
9755 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9756 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9757 the rules evaluation.
9758
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009759 - close :
9760 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9761 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9762 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9763 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9764 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9765 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009766 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009767 protocols.
9768
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009769 - reject :
9770 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9771 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009772 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009773
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009774 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9775 Sets a variable.
9776
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009777 - unset-var(<var-name>)
9778 Unsets a variable.
9779
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009780 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9781 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9782 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9783 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9784
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009785 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9786 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9787 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9788 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9789
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009790 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
9791 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9792 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9793 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9794 continues.
9795
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009796 - "silent-drop" :
9797 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009798 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009799 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9800 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9801 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9802 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9803 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009804 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9805 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009806 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9807 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009808 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009809 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9810 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9811 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9812 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9813
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009814 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
9815 Send a group of SPOE messages.
9816
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009817 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9818 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9819 for changing the default action to a reject.
9820
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009821 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9822 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9823 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9824 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009825 period.
9826
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009827 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9828 declared inline.
9829
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009830 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9831 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009832 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009833 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9834 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009835 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009836 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009837 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009838 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9839 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009840 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009841 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9842 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009843
9844 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9845 followed by some converters.
9846
9847 Example:
9848
9849 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9850
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009851 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9852 <var-name>.
9853
9854 Example:
9855
9856 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
9857
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009858 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9859 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9860 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9861 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9862 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9863
9864 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9865
9866 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9867
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009868 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9869
9870 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
9871
9872
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009873tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9874 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
9875 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9876 no | yes | yes | no
9877 Arguments :
9878 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9879 below.
9880
9881 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9882
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009883 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009884 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
9885 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
9886 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
9887 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
9888 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
9889 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
9890 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009891 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009892 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
9893 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
9894 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
9895 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
9896 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
9897 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
9898 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
9899 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
9900 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
9901 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
9902 instead.
9903
9904 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9905 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9906 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
9907 rules which may be inserted.
9908
9909 Several types of actions are supported :
9910 - accept : the request is accepted
9911 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9912 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
9913 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009914 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009915 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
9916 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009917 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009918 - silent-drop
9919
9920 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
9921 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
9922 sections for a complete description.
9923
9924 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9925 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9926 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
9927
9928 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
9929 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
9930 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
9931 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
9932 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
9933
9934 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9935 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9936
9937 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9938 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
9939 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
9940
9941 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9942 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
9943 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9944
9945 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
9946 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9947 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
9948
9949 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9950 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9951 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
9952
9953 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9954
9955 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
9956
9957
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009958tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
9959 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
9960 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9961 no | no | yes | yes
9962 Arguments :
9963 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9964 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9965 as explained at the top of this document.
9966
9967 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
9968
9969
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009970timeout check <timeout>
9971 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
9972 established.
9973
9974 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9975 yes | no | yes | yes
9976 Arguments:
9977 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9978 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9979 as explained at the top of this document.
9980
9981 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
9982 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009983 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009984 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01009985 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
9986 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
9987 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009988
9989 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
9990 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
9991
9992 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
9993 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009994 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009995
9996 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9997 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9998 forget about it.
9999
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010000 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10001 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010002
10003
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010004timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010005 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10006 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10007 yes | yes | yes | no
10008 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010009 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010010 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10011 as explained at the top of this document.
10012
10013 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10014 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10015 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010016 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10017 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10018 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10019 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010020 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10021 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10022 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010023 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010024 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010025 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10026 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010027 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10028 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010029
10030 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10031 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10032 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10033 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010034 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010035 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10036
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010037 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010038
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010039 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010040
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010041
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010042timeout client-fin <timeout>
10043 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10044 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10045 yes | yes | yes | no
10046 Arguments :
10047 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10048 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10049 as explained at the top of this document.
10050
10051 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10052 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10053 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10054 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10055 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10056 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10057 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010058 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10059 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10060 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010061
10062 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10063 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10064 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10065
10066 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10067
10068
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010069timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010070 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10071 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10072 yes | no | yes | yes
10073 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010074 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010075 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10076 as explained at the top of this document.
10077
10078 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010079 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010080 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010081 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010082 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10083 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010084
10085 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10086 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10087 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10088 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010089 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010090 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10091
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010092 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010093
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010094
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010095timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10096 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10097 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10098 yes | yes | yes | yes
10099 Arguments :
10100 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10101 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10102 as explained at the top of this document.
10103
10104 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10105 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10106 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10107 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10108 once the request has started to present itself.
10109
10110 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10111 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10112 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10113 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10114 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10115
10116 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10117 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10118 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10119 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10120
10121 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10122 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010123 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010124 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10125 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010126 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010127
10128 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10129 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10130 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10131 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10132
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010133 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10134 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010135 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10136
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010137 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10138
10139
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010140timeout http-request <timeout>
10141 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10142 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010143 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010144 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010145 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010146 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10147 as explained at the top of this document.
10148
10149 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10150 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10151 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10152 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10153 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10154 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10155 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010156 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10157 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10158 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10159 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010160 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010161 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10162 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010163
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010164 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10165 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10166 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10167 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10168 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010169 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010170
10171 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10172 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010173 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010174 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10175 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10176
10177 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010178 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10179 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10180 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010181
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010182 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010183 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010184
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010185
10186timeout queue <timeout>
10187 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10188 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10189 yes | no | yes | yes
10190 Arguments :
10191 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10192 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10193 as explained at the top of this document.
10194
10195 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10196 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10197 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10198 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10199 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10200
10201 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10202 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10203 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10204 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10205
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010206 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010207
10208
10209timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010210 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10211 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10212 yes | no | yes | yes
10213 Arguments :
10214 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10215 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10216 as explained at the top of this document.
10217
10218 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10219 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10220 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10221 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10222 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10223 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10224 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10225
10226 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10227 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10228 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10229 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10230 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010231 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010232 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010233 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10234 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010235 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10236 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010237
10238 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10239 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10240 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10241 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010242 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010243 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10244
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010245 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010246
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010247
10248timeout server-fin <timeout>
10249 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10250 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10251 yes | no | yes | yes
10252 Arguments :
10253 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10254 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10255 as explained at the top of this document.
10256
10257 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10258 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10259 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10260 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10261 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10262 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10263 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10264 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10265 situations, it should not be needed.
10266
10267 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10268 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10269 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10270
10271 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10272
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010273
10274timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010275 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010276 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10277 yes | yes | yes | yes
10278 Arguments :
10279 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10280 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10281 as explained at the top of this document.
10282
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020010283 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
10284 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
10285 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010286
10287 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10288 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10289 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10290 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010291 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010292
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010293 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010294
10295
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010296timeout tunnel <timeout>
10297 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10299 yes | no | yes | yes
10300 Arguments :
10301 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10302 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10303 as explained at the top of this document.
10304
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010305 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010306 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10307 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10308 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010309 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10310 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010311 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10312 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10313 specified.
10314
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010315 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10316 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10317 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10318 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10319 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10320 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10321 state.
10322
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010323 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10324 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10325 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10326 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010327 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010328
10329 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10330 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10331 forget about it.
10332
10333 Example :
10334 defaults http
10335 option http-server-close
10336 timeout connect 5s
10337 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010338 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010339 timeout server 30s
10340 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10341
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010342 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010343
10344
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010345transparent (deprecated)
10346 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10347 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010348 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010349 Arguments : none
10350
10351 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10352 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10353 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10354 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10355 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10356 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10357 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10358 appropriate server.
10359
10360 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10361
10362 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10363 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10364
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010365 See also: "option transparent"
10366
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010367unique-id-format <string>
10368 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10369 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10370 yes | yes | yes | no
10371 Arguments :
10372 <string> is a log-format string.
10373
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010374 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10375 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10376 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10377 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010378
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010379 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10380 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10381 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10382 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10383 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10384 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10385 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10386 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010387
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010388 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10389 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010390
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010391 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010392
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010393 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010394
10395 will generate:
10396
10397 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10398
10399 See also: "unique-id-header"
10400
10401unique-id-header <name>
10402 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10403 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10404 yes | yes | yes | no
10405 Arguments :
10406 <name> is the name of the header.
10407
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010408 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10409 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010410
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010411 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010412
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010413 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010414 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10415
10416 will generate:
10417
10418 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10419
10420 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010421
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010422use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010423 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010424 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10425 no | yes | yes | no
10426 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010427 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10428 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010429
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010430 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10431 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010432
10433 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10434 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10435 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010436 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010437 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010438 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10439 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010440
10441 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10442 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10443 assign the backend.
10444
10445 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10446 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10447 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10448 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10449 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10450 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10451
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010452 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010453 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010454 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10455 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10456 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10457
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010458 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10459 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10460 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10461 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10462 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10463 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10464 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10465 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10466 cannot be forced from the request.
10467
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010468 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010469 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10470 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10471
10472 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10473 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010474
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010475
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010476use-server <server> if <condition>
10477use-server <server> unless <condition>
10478 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10479 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10480 no | no | yes | yes
10481 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010482 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010483
10484 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10485
10486 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10487 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10488 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10489
10490 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10491 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10492 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10493 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10494 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10495 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10496 matches will assign the server.
10497
10498 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10499 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10500 with the next rules until one matches.
10501
10502 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10503 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10504 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10505 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10506
10507 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10508 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10509 stripped.
10510
10511 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10512 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10513 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10514 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10515
10516 Example :
10517 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10518 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10519 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10520 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10521 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10522 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010523 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010524 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10525 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10526
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010527 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010528
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010529
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100105305. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010531--------------------------
10532
10533The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10534depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10535settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10536written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10537described in this section.
10538
10539
105405.1. Bind options
10541-----------------
10542
10543The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10544as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10545no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10546parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10547while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10548provided immediately after the setting name.
10549
10550The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10551
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010552accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10553 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10554 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10555 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10556 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10557 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10558 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10559 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10560 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10561 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010562 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10563 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10564 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010565
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010566accept-proxy
10567 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010568 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10569 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010570 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10571 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10572 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10573 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010574 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010575 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10576 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010577 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10578 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010579
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010580allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010010581 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010010582 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010583 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010010584 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
10585 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010586
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010587alpn <protocols>
10588 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10589 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10590 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010591 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010592 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010593 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
10594 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
10595 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
10596 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
10597 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
10598 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
10599 preference, like below :
10600
10601 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010602
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010603backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010010604 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010605 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10606
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010607curves <curves>
10608 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10609 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10610 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10611 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10612 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10613 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10614
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010615ecdhe <named curve>
10616 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010617 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10618 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010619
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010620ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010621 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10622 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10623 client's certificate.
10624
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010625ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10626 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10627 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10628 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10629 error is ignored.
10630
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010631ca-sign-file <cafile>
10632 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10633 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10634 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10635 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10636 'generate-certificates' for details.
10637
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010638ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010639 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10640 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10641 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10642 'generate-certificates' for details.
10643
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010644ciphers <ciphers>
10645 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10646 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000010647 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000010648 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020010649 information and recommendations see e.g.
10650 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
10651 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
10652 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
10653
10654ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
10655 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
10656 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
10657 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
10658 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000010659 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
10660 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010661
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010662crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010663 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10664 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10665 to verify client's certificate.
10666
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010667crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010668 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10669 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10670 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10671 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10672 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10673 file.
10674
10675 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10676 are loaded.
10677
10678 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010679 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010680 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10681 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10682 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10683 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010684 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10685 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010686 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010687
10688 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10689 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10690 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10691 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010692 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10693 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010694
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010695 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010696
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010697 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010698 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010699 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
10700 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010701 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10702 clients).
10703
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010704 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10705 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10706 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10707 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10708 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10709 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10710 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10711 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10712 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10713 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10714 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10715 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10716 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10717
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010718 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10719 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10720 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10721 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10722 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10723
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010724 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10725 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10726 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10727 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010728
10729 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10730 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10731 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10732 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10733 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10734 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10735 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10736 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10737 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10738
10739 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10740
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010741 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010742 a cert bundle.
10743
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010744 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010745 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10746 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10747 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10748 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
10749 provide multi-cert support.
10750
10751 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
10752
10753 Filename | CN | SAN
10754 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10755 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010756 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010757 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
10758 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10759
10760 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
10761 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
10762 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
10763 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010764 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
10765 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
10766 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010767
10768 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
10769 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
10770
10771 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
10772 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
10773 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
10774
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010775crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010776 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010777 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010778 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010779 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010780
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010781crt-list <file>
10782 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010783 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
10784 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010785
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010786 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
10787
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020010788 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
10789 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010790 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010791 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010792
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010793 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
10794 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
10795 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
10796 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
10797 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
10798 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
10799 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
10800 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010801
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010802 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020010803 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010804 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
10805 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
10806 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010807
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010808 crt-list file example:
10809 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010810 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010811 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010812 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010813
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010814defer-accept
10815 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10816 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
10817 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010818 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010819 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
10820 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
10821 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
10822 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
10823 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
10824 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
10825 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
10826
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010827expose-fd listeners
10828 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
10829 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020010830 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
10831 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010832 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010833
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010834force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010835 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010836 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010837 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010838 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010839
10840force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010841 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010842 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010843 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010844
10845force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010846 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010847 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010848 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010849
10850force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010851 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010852 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010853 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010854
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010855force-tlsv13
10856 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
10857 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010858 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010859
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010860generate-certificates
10861 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10862 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
10863 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
10864 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
10865 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
10866 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
10867 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
10868 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
10869 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
10870 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
10871 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
10872
10873 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
10874 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010875 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010876 certificate is used many times.
10877
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010878gid <gid>
10879 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
10880 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10881 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
10882 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
10883 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10884
10885group <group>
10886 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
10887 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
10888 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
10889 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
10890 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10891
10892id <id>
10893 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
10894 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
10895 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
10896 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
10897
10898interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010010899 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
10900 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
10901 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
10902 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
10903 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
10904 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010010905 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
10906 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
10907 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
10908 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
10909 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
10910 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010911
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010912level <level>
10913 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
10914 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
10915 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010916 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010917 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
10918 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
10919 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010920 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010921 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010922 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010923 all counters).
10924
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020010925severity-output <format>
10926 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
10927 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
10928 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
10929 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
10930 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
10931 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
10932 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
10933 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
10934 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
10935 rfc5424 convention.
10936
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010937maxconn <maxconn>
10938 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
10939 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
10940 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
10941 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
10942 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
10943 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
10944 eat all memory.
10945
10946mode <mode>
10947 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
10948 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
10949 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
10950 UNIX sockets.
10951
10952mss <maxseg>
10953 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
10954 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
10955 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
10956 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
10957 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
10958 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
10959 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
10960 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
10961 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
10962 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
10963 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
10964
10965name <name>
10966 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
10967 page.
10968
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010969namespace <name>
10970 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10971 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
10972 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10973 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10974
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010975nice <nice>
10976 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
10977 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
10978 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
10979 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
10980 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
10981 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
10982 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
10983 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
10984 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
10985 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
10986 one for an RDP socket.
10987
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020010988no-ca-names
10989 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10990 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
10991
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010992no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010993 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010994 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010995 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010996 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010997 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
10998 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010999
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011000no-tls-tickets
11001 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11002 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11003 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011004 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11005 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011006
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011007no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011008 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011009 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011010 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011011 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011012 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11013 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011014
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011015no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011016 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011017 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011018 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011019 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011020 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11021 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011022
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011023no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011024 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011025 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011026 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011027 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011028 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11029 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011030
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011031no-tlsv13
11032 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11033 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11034 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11035 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011036 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11037 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011038
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011039npn <protocols>
11040 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11041 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11042 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011043 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011044 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011045 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11046 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11047 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11048 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11049 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011050
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011051prefer-client-ciphers
11052 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11053 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11054 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011055 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11056 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11057 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011058
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011059process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011060 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011061 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011062 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011063 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11064 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11065 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11066 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011067 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011068 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11069 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11070 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11071 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11072 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011073
11074 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11075
11076 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11077 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11078 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11079 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11080 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11081 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11082 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11083 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011084
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011085proto <name>
11086 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11087 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11088 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11089 in haproxy -vv.
11090 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11091 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011092 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011093 h2" on the bind line.
11094
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011095ssl
11096 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011097 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011098 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11099 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011100 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11101 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011102
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011103ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11104 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11105 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11106 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11107
11108ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11109 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11110 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11111 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11112
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011113strict-sni
11114 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11115 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11116 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11117 See the "crt" option for more information.
11118
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011119tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011120 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011121 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11122 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011123 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011124 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11125 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11126 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11127 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11128 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11129 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11130 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11131
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011132tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011133 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011134 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11135 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11136 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11137 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11138 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11139 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11140 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011141 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11142 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11143 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011144
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011145tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11146 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011147 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11148 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11149 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11150 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11151 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11152 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11153 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11154 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11155 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11156 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011157 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11158 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11159
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011160transparent
11161 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11162 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11163 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11164 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11165 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11166 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11167 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11168 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11169 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11170 so check for support with your vendor.
11171
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011172v4v6
11173 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11174 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11175 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11176 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011177 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011178
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011179v6only
11180 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11181 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11182 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011183 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11184 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011185
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011186uid <uid>
11187 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11188 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11189 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11190 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11191 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11192
11193user <user>
11194 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11195 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11196 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11197 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11198 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11199
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011200verify [none|optional|required]
11201 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11202 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11203 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11204 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11205 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011206 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11207 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11208 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11209 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011210
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200112115.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011212------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011213
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011214The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11215which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11216arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11217settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11218after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11219Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11220address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011221
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011222 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011223 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011224
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011225Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11226keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11227
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011228The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011229
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011230addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011231 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011232 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11233 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11234 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11235 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11236 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011237
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011238agent-check
11239 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011240 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010011241 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
11242 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
11243 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011244
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011245 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011246 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011247 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11248 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11249 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011250
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011251 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11252 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11253 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11254 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11255 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011256
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011257 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011258 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011259
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011260 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11261 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11262 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011263
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011264 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11265 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11266 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011267
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011268 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11269 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11270 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11271 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11272 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011273 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011274 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011275
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011276 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11277 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011278
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011279 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11280 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11281 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11282 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11283 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11284 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11285 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11286 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11287 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011288
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011289 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11290 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011291 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11292 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11293 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011294 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011295
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011296 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011297 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011298
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011299agent-send <string>
11300 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11301 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11302 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11303 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11304 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11305
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011306agent-inter <delay>
11307 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11308 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11309
11310 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11311 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11312 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11313 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11314 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11315 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11316 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11317 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11318 of backends use the same servers.
11319
11320 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11321
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011322agent-addr <addr>
11323 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11324
11325 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11326 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11327 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11328 hostname, it will be resolved.
11329
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011330agent-port <port>
11331 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11332
11333 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11334
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011335allow-0rtt
11336 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020011337 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
11338 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011339
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011340alpn <protocols>
11341 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11342 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11343 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011344 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011345 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
11346 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
11347 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11348 now obsolete NPN extension.
11349 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
11350 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
11351
11352 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
11353
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011354backup
11355 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11356 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11357 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11358 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011359 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11360 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011361
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011362ca-file <cafile>
11363 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11364 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11365 server's certificate.
11366
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011367check
11368 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011369 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11370 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11371 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11372 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11373 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11374 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11375 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011376 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11377 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011378 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11379 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011380
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011381check-send-proxy
11382 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11383 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11384 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11385 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11386 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11387 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11388 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11389
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010011390check-alpn <protocols>
11391 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
11392 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
11393 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11394
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011395check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011396 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011397 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
11398 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011399
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011400check-ssl
11401 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11402 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11403 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11404 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011405 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011406 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11407 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011408 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011409 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11410 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011411
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080011412check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011413 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080011414 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
11415 for normal traffic.
11416
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011417ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011418 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
11419 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
11420 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011421 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
11422 information and recommendations see e.g.
11423 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11424 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11425 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011426
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011427ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11428 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11429 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
11430 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
11431 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011432 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
11433 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
11434 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011435
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011436cookie <value>
11437 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11438 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11439 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11440 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11441 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11442 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11443 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11444
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011445crl-file <crlfile>
11446 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11447 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11448 to verify server's certificate.
11449
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011450crt <cert>
11451 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11452 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11453 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11454 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11455 certificate request.
11456
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011457disabled
11458 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11459 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11460 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11461 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11462 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011463 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011464
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011465enabled
11466 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11467 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11468 default value.
11469 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11470 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011471
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011472error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011473 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11474 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11475 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011476
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011477 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011478
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011479fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011480 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11481 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11482 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11483
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011484force-sslv3
11485 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11486 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011487 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011488 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011489
11490force-tlsv10
11491 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011492 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011493 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011494
11495force-tlsv11
11496 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011497 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011498 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011499
11500force-tlsv12
11501 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011502 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011503 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011504
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011505force-tlsv13
11506 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11507 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011508 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011509
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011510id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011511 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11512 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11513 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011514
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011515init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11516 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11517 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011518 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011519 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11520 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11521 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11522 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11523 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11524 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11525 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11526 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11527 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011528 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011529 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11530 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11531 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11532 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11533 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11534 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011535 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011536
11537 Example:
11538 defaults
11539 # never fail on address resolution
11540 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11541
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011542inter <delay>
11543fastinter <delay>
11544downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011545 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11546 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11547 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11548 between checks depending on the server state :
11549
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011550 Server state | Interval used
11551 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11552 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11553 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11554 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11555 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11556 or yet unchecked. |
11557 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11558 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11559 | "inter" otherwise.
11560 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011561
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011562 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11563 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11564 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11565 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011566 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11567 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11568 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11569 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11570 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011571
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011572maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011573 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11574 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
11575 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
11576 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
11577 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11578 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11579 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11580 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11581
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011582maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011583 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11584 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11585 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11586 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11587 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11588 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11589 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11590
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010011591max-reuse <count>
11592 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
11593 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
11594 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
11595 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
11596 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
11597 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
11598 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
11599 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
11600
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011601minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011602 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11603 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11604 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11605 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11606 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11607 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011608 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011609 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011610
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011611namespace <name>
11612 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11613 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11614 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11615 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11616
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011617no-agent-check
11618 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11619 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11620 default value.
11621 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11622 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11623
11624no-backup
11625 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11626 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11627 default value.
11628 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11629 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11630
11631no-check
11632 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11633 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11634 default value.
11635 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11636 "default-server" "check" setting.
11637
11638no-check-ssl
11639 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11640 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11641 default value.
11642 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11643 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11644
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011645no-send-proxy
11646 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11647 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11648 default value.
11649 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11650 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11651
11652no-send-proxy-v2
11653 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11654 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11655 default value.
11656 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11657 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11658
11659no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11660 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11661 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11662 default value.
11663 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11664 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11665
11666no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11667 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11668 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11669 default value.
11670 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11671 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11672
11673no-ssl
11674 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11675 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11676 default value.
11677 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11678 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11679
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011680no-ssl-reuse
11681 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11682 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11683 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11684 and for paranoid users.
11685
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011686no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011687 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11688 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011689 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011690
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011691 Supported in default-server: No
11692
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011693no-tls-tickets
11694 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11695 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11696 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011697 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11698 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011699 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011700
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011701no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011702 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011703 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11704 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011705 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11706 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011707 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011708
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011709 Supported in default-server: No
11710
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011711no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011712 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011713 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11714 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011715 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11716 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011717 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011718
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011719 Supported in default-server: No
11720
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011721no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011722 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011723 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11724 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011725 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11726 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011727 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011728
11729 Supported in default-server: No
11730
11731no-tlsv13
11732 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11733 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11734 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
11735 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11736 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011737 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011738
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011739 Supported in default-server: No
11740
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011741no-verifyhost
11742 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
11743 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11744 default value.
11745 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11746 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011747
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020011748no-tfo
11749 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
11750 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11751 default value.
11752 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11753 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
11754
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090011755non-stick
11756 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
11757 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
11758 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
11759
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011760npn <protocols>
11761 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11762 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11763 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011764 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011765 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
11766 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11767 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
11768
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011769observe <mode>
11770 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
11771 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
11772 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
11773 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
11774 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
11775 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010011776 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011777
11778 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
11779
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011780on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011781 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
11782 Currently, four modes are available:
11783 - fastinter: force fastinter
11784 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
11785 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
11786 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
11787 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
11788
11789 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
11790
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011791on-marked-down <action>
11792 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
11793 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011794 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
11795 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
11796 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
11797 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
11798 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
11799 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
11800 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
11801 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011802
11803 Actions are disabled by default
11804
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011805on-marked-up <action>
11806 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
11807 Currently one action is available:
11808 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
11809 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
11810 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
11811 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011812 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
11813 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011814 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
11815 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
11816
11817 Actions are disabled by default
11818
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010011819pool-max-conn <max>
11820 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
11821 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
11822 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
11823 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
11824 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
11825 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
11826
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010011827pool-purge-delay <delay>
11828 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010011829 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020011830 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010011831
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011832port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011833 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
11834 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
11835 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
11836 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
11837 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
11838 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
11839
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020011840proto <name>
11841
11842 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
11843 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
11844 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
11845 reported in haproxy -vv.
11846 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11847 protocol for all connections established to this server.
11848
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011849redir <prefix>
11850 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
11851 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
11852 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
11853 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
11854 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
11855 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
11856 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
11857 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011858 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011859 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011860 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
11861 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
11862 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
11863 loop between the client and HAProxy!
11864
11865 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
11866
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011867rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011868 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
11869 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
11870 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
11871
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020011872resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
11873 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
11874 server.
11875
11876 Available options:
11877
11878 * allow-dup-ip
11879 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
11880 resolution at runtime is in operation.
11881 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
11882 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
11883 For such case, simply enable this option.
11884 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
11885
11886 * prevent-dup-ip
11887 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
11888 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
11889 same fqdn.
11890 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
11891
11892 Example:
11893 backend b_myapp
11894 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
11895 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
11896 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
11897
11898 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
11899 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
11900 it
11901 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
11902 different address
11903
11904 Default value: not set
11905
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011906resolve-prefer <family>
11907 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
11908 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
11909 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
11910 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
11911
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020011912 Default value: ipv6
11913
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011914 Example:
11915
11916 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011917
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011918resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011919 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011920 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011921 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011922 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
11923 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011924 configured network, another address is selected.
11925
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011926 Example:
11927
11928 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011929
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011930resolvers <id>
11931 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
11932 hostname.
11933
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011934 Example:
11935
11936 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011937
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011938 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011939
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011940send-proxy
11941 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
11942 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
11943 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
11944 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011945 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
11946 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
11947 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
11948 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
11949 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
11950 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
11951 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
11952 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
11953 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
11954 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011955 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
11956 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011957
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011958send-proxy-v2
11959 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
11960 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11961 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11962 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020011963 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
11964 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
11965 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
11966 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011967
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010011968proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
11969 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
11970 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010011971 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
11972 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010011973 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
11974 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010011975 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010011976
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011977send-proxy-v2-ssl
11978 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11979 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11980 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11981 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11982 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11983 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
11984 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011985 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
11986 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011987
11988send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11989 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11990 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11991 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11992 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11993 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11994 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
11995 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
11996 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011997 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
11998 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011999
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012000slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012001 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12002 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12003 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12004 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12005 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12006 parameters :
12007
12008 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12009 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12010
12011 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12012 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12013 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12014 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12015
12016 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12017 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12018 seen as failed.
12019
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012020sni <expression>
12021 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12022 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12023 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12024 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012025 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12026 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012027 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012028 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12029 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012030
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012031source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012032source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012033source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012034 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12035 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12036 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12037 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12038
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012039 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12040 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12041 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12042 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12043 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12044 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12045 server.
12046
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012047 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12048 specifying the source address without port(s).
12049
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012050ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012051 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12052 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12053 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12054 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12055 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12056 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012057 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12058 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012059
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012060ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12061 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12062 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12063 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12064
12065ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12066 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12067 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12068 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12069
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012070ssl-reuse
12071 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12072 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12073 default value.
12074 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12075 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12076
12077stick
12078 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12079 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12080 default value.
12081 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12082 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012083
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012084socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012085 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012086 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
12087 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
12088
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012089tcp-ut <delay>
12090 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12091 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12092 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012093 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012094 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12095 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12096 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12097 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12098 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12099 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12100 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12101 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12102 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12103
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012104tfo
12105 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
12106 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
12107 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
12108 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
12109 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012110 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012111
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012112track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012113 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12114 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12115 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12116 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012117 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12118
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012119tls-tickets
12120 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12121 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12122 default value.
12123 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12124 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012125
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012126verify [none|required]
12127 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012128 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012129 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12130 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012131 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012132 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12133 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12134 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12135 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12136 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12137 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12138 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12139 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012140
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012141verifyhost <hostname>
12142 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012143 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12144 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12145 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12146 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12147 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12148 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12149 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12150 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012151
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012152weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012153 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12154 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12155 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012156 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12157 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12158 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12159 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12160 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12161 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012162
12163
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200121645.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12165-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012166
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012167HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12168using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12169configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012170This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12171can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12172workload.
12173This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12174resolution at run time.
12175Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12176carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12177
12178
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200121795.3.1. Global overview
12180----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012181
12182As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12183different steps of the process life:
12184
12185 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12186 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12187 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12188
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012189 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12190 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012191
12192A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12193 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12194 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12195 resolution to know this new IP.
12196
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012197When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012198HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012199SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12200from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12201will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12202will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012203
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012204A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012205 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012206 first valid response.
12207
12208 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12209 servers return an error.
12210
12211
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200122125.3.2. The resolvers section
12213----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012214
12215This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012216HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12217contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012218
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012219When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12220uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12221is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12222answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12223
12224When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012225used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012226
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012227 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12228 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12229 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012230
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012231 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12232 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012233
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012234 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12235 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12236 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012237
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012238For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12239following scenarios are possible:
12240
12241 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12242 ignored
12243
12244 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12245 applied
12246
12247 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12248 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12249
12250 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12251 retries the query with a new type
12252
12253 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12254 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012255
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012256As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12257a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012258<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012259
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012260
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012261resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012262 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012263
12264A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12265
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012266accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012267 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012268 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012269 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12270 by RFC 6891)
12271
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012272 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12273
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012274nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12275 DNS server description:
12276 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12277 <ip> : IP address of the server
12278 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12279
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012280parse-resolv-conf
12281 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
12282 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
12283 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
12284
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012285hold <status> <period>
12286 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12287 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012288 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012289 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012290 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12291 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12292 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12293
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012294 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012295
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012296resolve_retries <nb>
12297 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12298 giving up.
12299 Default value: 3
12300
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012301 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12302 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12303 type.
12304
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012305timeout <event> <time>
12306 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12307 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12308 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012309 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12310 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012311 Default value: 1s
12312 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012313 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012314 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012315 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12316 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12317
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012318 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012319
12320 resolvers mydns
12321 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12322 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012323 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012324 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012325 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012326 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012327 hold other 30s
12328 hold refused 30s
12329 hold nx 30s
12330 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012331 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012332 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012333
12334
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123356. HTTP header manipulation
12336---------------------------
12337
12338In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
12339response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
12340request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
12341which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012342against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012343
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012344If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
12345to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
12346but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
12347HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
12348stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
12349because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
12350a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
12351still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020012352
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012353This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
12354in section 4.2 :
12355
12356 - reqadd <string>
12357 - reqallow <search>
12358 - reqiallow <search>
12359 - reqdel <search>
12360 - reqidel <search>
12361 - reqdeny <search>
12362 - reqideny <search>
12363 - reqpass <search>
12364 - reqipass <search>
12365 - reqrep <search> <replace>
12366 - reqirep <search> <replace>
12367 - reqtarpit <search>
12368 - reqitarpit <search>
12369 - rspadd <string>
12370 - rspdel <search>
12371 - rspidel <search>
12372 - rspdeny <search>
12373 - rspideny <search>
12374 - rsprep <search> <replace>
12375 - rspirep <search> <replace>
12376
12377With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
12378is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
12379parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
12380prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
12381Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
12382
12383 \t for a tab
12384 \r for a carriage return (CR)
12385 \n for a new line (LF)
12386 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
12387 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
12388 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
12389 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
12390 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
12391
12392The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
12393portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
12394above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
12395regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
123969 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
12397is very common to users of the "sed" program.
12398
12399The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
12400after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
12401
12402Notes related to these keywords :
12403---------------------------------
12404 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
12405 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
12406 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
12407
12408 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
12409 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
12410 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
12411
12412 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
12413 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
12414 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
12415 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
12416 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
12417
12418 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
12419 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
12420 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
12421 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
12422 useless headers before adding new ones.
12423
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012424 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012425 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
12426
12427 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
12428 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
12429 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
12430
12431 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
12432 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012433 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012434
12435
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200124366. Cache
12437---------
12438
12439HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
12440(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
12441RAM.
12442
12443The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
12444this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
12445
12446If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
12447independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
12448when we try to allocate a new one.
12449
12450The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
12451
12452It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
12453"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
12454for more details.
12455
12456When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
12457replaced by "<CACHE>".
12458
12459
124606.1. Limitation
12461----------------
12462
12463The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
12464
12465- If the response is not a 200
12466- If the response contains a Vary header
12467- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
12468- If the response is not cacheable
12469
12470- If the request is not a GET
12471- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
12472- If the request contains an Authorization header
12473
12474
124756.2. Setup
12476-----------
12477
12478To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
12479the corresponding http-request and response actions.
12480
12481
124826.2.1. Cache section
12483---------------------
12484
12485cache <name>
12486 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
12487 size of cache is mandatory.
12488
12489total-max-size <megabytes>
12490 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
12491 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
12492
12493max-object-size <bytes>
12494 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
12495 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
12496 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
12497
12498max-age <seconds>
12499 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
12500 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
12501 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
12502 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
12503 default.
12504
12505
125066.2.2. Proxy section
12507---------------------
12508
12509http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12510 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
12511 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
12512 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
12513 after this one.
12514
12515http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12516 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
12517 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
12518 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
12519 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
12520
12521
12522Example:
12523
12524 backend bck1
12525 mode http
12526
12527 http-request cache-use foobar
12528 http-response cache-store foobar
12529 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
12530
12531 cache foobar
12532 total-max-size 4
12533 max-age 240
12534
12535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200125367. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12537----------------------------------
12538
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012539HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012540client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12541The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12542these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12543but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12544data called patterns.
12545
12546
125477.1. ACL basics
12548---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012549
12550The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12551content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12552from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12553simple :
12554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012555 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012556 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012557 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12558 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012559
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012560The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12561adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012562
12563In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012565 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012566
12567This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12568Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12569and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012570an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12571conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12572as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12573are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012574
12575ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12576'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12577which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12578
12579There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12580performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12581
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012582The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12583specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12584this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012585methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12586ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012587
12588Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12589 - boolean
12590 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12591 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12592 - string
12593 - data block
12594
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012595Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12596converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12597would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12598The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12599which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12600
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012601Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12602keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12603fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12604which are summarized in the table below :
12605
12606 +---------------------+-----------------+
12607 | Sample or converter | Default |
12608 | output type | matching method |
12609 +---------------------+-----------------+
12610 | boolean | bool |
12611 +---------------------+-----------------+
12612 | integer | int |
12613 +---------------------+-----------------+
12614 | ip | ip |
12615 +---------------------+-----------------+
12616 | string | str |
12617 +---------------------+-----------------+
12618 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12619 +---------------------+-----------------+
12620
12621Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12622matching method, see below.
12623
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012624The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12625 - boolean
12626 - integer or integer range
12627 - IP address / network
12628 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12629 - regular expression
12630 - hex block
12631
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012632The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12633
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012634 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12635 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012636 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012637 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012638 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012639 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012640 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
12641
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012642The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
12643read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
12644if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
12645lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
12646will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
12647beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
12648a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
12649lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
12650exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
12651
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012652The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
12653parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
12654ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
12655a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
12656check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
12657
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012658The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
12659socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
12660file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
12661
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012662Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
12663loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
12664
12665 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
12666
12667In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
12668the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
12669case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
12670as well.
12671
12672The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
12673sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
12674do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
12675methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
12676is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012677obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012678followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
12679default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
12680that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
12681string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
12682
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012683The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
12684By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
12685string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
12686resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
12687server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012688waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012689flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
12690function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
12691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012692There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
12693sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
12694be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012695
12696 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
12697 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012698 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
12699 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
12700 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
12701 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012702
12703 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
12704 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012705 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012706
12707 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012708 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012709
12710 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012711 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012712
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012713 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012714 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
12715
12716 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
12717 binary or string samples.
12718
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012719 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
12720 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012721
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012722 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
12723 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
12724 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012725
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012726 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
12727 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012729 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
12730 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012731
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012732 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
12733 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012734
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012735 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
12736 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012737 This may be used with binary or string samples.
12738
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012739 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
12740 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
12741 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012742
12743For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
12744request, it is possible to do :
12745
12746 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
12747
12748In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12749buffer, one would use the following acl :
12750
12751 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12752
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012753On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12754possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12755
12756 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12757
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012758All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12759criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12760method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12761to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12762criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12763the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012764
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012765If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012766the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
12767For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012768
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012769 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
12770 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
12771 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
12772 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012773
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012774
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012775The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
12776types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
12777combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
12778brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
12779default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012780
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012781 +-------------------------------------------------+
12782 | Input sample type |
12783 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012784 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012785 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12786 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
12787 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012788 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012789 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012790 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012791 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012792 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012793 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012794 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012795 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012796 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012797 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012798 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012799 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012800 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012801 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012802 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012803 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012804 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012805 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012806 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012807 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012808 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012809 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12810 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12811 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012812
12813
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200128147.1.1. Matching booleans
12815------------------------
12816
12817In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
12818Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
12819When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
12820that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
12821
12822Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
12823return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
12824"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
12825
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012826
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200128277.1.2. Matching integers
12828------------------------
12829
12830Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
12831enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
12832to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
12833
12834Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
12835matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
12836lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012837
12838For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
12839unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
12840representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
12841
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012842As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
12843two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
12844instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
12845ranges and operators.
12846
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012847For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012848operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
12849Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
12850of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012851
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012852Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012853
12854 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
12855 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
12856 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
12857 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
12858 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
12859
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012860For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012861
12862 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
12863
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012864This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
12865
12866 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
12867
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012868
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200128697.1.3. Matching strings
12870-----------------------
12871
12872String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
12873different forms :
12874
12875 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012876 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012877
12878 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012879 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012880
12881 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
12882 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12883
12884 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
12885 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12886
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010012887 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012888 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
12889 matches.
12890
12891 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
12892 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
12893 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012894
12895String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
12896exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
12897characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
12898string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
12899to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012900before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012901
12902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129037.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
12904---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012905
12906Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
12907they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
12908possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
12909passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
12910the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012911the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
12912match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012913
12914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129157.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
12916-------------------------------------
12917
12918It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
12919not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
12920a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
12921to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
12922digits may be used upper or lower case.
12923
12924Example :
12925 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
12926 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
12927
12928
129297.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
12930---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012931
12932IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
12933netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
12934within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012935host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012936difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
12937at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
12938does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
12939parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012940
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020012941The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
12942abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
12943
12944 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12945 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
12946 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12947 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
12948 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
12949 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
12950 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
12951 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12952
12953Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
12954192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
12955
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012956IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
12957Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
12958trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
12959IPv6 patterns.
12960
12961HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
12962following situations :
12963 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
12964 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
12965 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
12966 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
12967 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
12968 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
12969 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
12970 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
12971 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
12972 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
12973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012974
129757.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
12976----------------------------------
12977
12978Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
12979combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
12980
12981 - AND (implicit)
12982 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
12983 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012984
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012985A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012987 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012988
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012989Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
12990indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012992For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
12993"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
12994requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
12995is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
12996
12997 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012998 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
12999 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13000 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013001
13002To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13003and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13004
13005 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13006 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13007 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13008 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13009
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013010 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013011 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13012 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13013 use_backend www if host_www
13014
13015It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13016expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13017be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13018the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13019
13020 The following rule :
13021
13022 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013023 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013024
13025 Can also be written that way :
13026
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013027 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013028
13029It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13030to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13031simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13032sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13033good use is the following :
13034
13035 With named ACLs :
13036
13037 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13038 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13039 monitor fail if site_dead
13040
13041 With anonymous ACLs :
13042
13043 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13044
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013045See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13046keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013047
13048
130497.3. Fetching samples
13050---------------------
13051
13052Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13053against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13054sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13055ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13056of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13057available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13058
13059This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13060Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13061compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13062deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13063
13064The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13065matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13066method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13067indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13068
13069As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13070when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13071mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13072the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13073ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13074
13075Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13076multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13077when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013078incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13079are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013080is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13081all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13082
13083Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13084 - name
13085 - name(arg1)
13086 - name(arg1,arg2)
13087
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013088
130897.3.1. Converters
13090-----------------
13091
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013092Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13093of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13094is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13095was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013096has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013097unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13098
13099These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13100sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13101the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013102support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013103
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013104A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13105support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13106supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13107(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13108bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13109
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013110The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013111
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001311251d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13113 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13114 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13115 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13116 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13117 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13118
13119 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013120 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13121 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013122 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13123 frontend http-in
13124 bind *:8081
13125 default_backend servers
13126 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13127 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13128
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013129add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013130 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013131 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013132 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13133 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013134 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013135 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13136 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13137 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13138 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013139 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013140 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013141
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013142aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13143 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13144 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13145 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13146 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13147 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13148 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13149
13150 Example:
13151 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13152 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13153
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013154and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013155 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013156 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013157 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13158 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013159 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013160 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13161 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13162 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13163 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013164 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013165 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013166
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013167b64dec
13168 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13169 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13170
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013171base64
13172 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013173 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013174 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13175
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013176bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013177 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013178 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013179 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013180 presence of a flag).
13181
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013182bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13183 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13184 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013185 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013186
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013187concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13188 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13189 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13190 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13191 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13192 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13193 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13194 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13195 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13196 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13197 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013198 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. Note that due to the config
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013199 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013200 delimiters.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013201
13202 Example:
13203 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13204 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13205 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13206 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13207
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013208cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013209 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13210 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013211
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013212crc32([<avalanche>])
13213 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13214 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13215 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13216 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13217 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13218 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13219 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13220 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13221 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13222 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013223 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13224
13225crc32c([<avalanche>])
13226 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13227 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13228 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13229 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13230 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13231 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13232 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13233 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013234
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013235da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013236 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13237 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13238 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13239 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013240 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013241 configuration language.
13242
13243 Example:
13244 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013245 bind *:8881
13246 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013247 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013248
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013249debug
13250 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
13251 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
13252 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
13253
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013254div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013255 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13256 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013257 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013258 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13259 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013260 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013261 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13262 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13263 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13264 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013265 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013266 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013267
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013268djb2([<avalanche>])
13269 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13270 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13271 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13272 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13273 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13274 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13275 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013276 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13277 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013278
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013279even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013280 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013281 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13282
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013283field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13284 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13285 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13286 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13287 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13288 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13289 fields.
13290
13291 Example :
13292 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13293 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13294 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13295 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13296 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013297
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013298hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013299 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013300 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013301 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013302 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013303
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013304hex2i
13305 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013306 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013307
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013308http_date([<offset>])
13309 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13310 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
13311 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
13312 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
13313 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
13314 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013315
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013316in_table(<table>)
13317 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13318 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13319 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013320 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013321 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13322
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013323ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13324 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013325 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013326 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13327 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13328 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13329 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13330 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013331
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013332json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013333 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013334 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013335 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013336 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13337 of errors:
13338 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13339 bytes, ...)
13340 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13341 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13342
13343 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13344 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13345 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
13346 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
13347 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
13348 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013349 - "ascii" : never fails;
13350 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
13351 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013352 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013353 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013354 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
13355 characters corresponding to the other errors.
13356
13357 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013358 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013359
13360 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013361 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013362 capture request header user-agent len 150
13363 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013364
13365 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
13366 GET / HTTP/1.0
13367 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
13368
13369 Output log:
13370 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13371
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013372language(<value>[,<default>])
13373 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13374 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13375 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13376 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13377 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13378 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13379 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13380 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13381 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013382 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013383 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13384 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013385
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013386 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013387
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013388 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13389 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013390
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013391 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13392 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13393 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13394 use_backend spanish if es
13395 use_backend french if fr
13396 use_backend english if en
13397 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013398
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013399length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013400 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13401 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13402 type. The result is of type integer.
13403
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013404lower
13405 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13406 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13407 type. The result is of type string.
13408
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013409ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
13410 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13411 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
13412 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13413 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13414 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13415 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
13416
13417 Example :
13418
13419 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013420 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013421 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13422
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013423map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13424map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13425map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13426 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
13427 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
13428 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
13429 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
13430 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
13431 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
13432 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
13433 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013434
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013435 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
13436 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
13437 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013438
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013439 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013440 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013441
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013442 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
13443 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13444 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
13445 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020013446 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
13447 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013448 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
13449 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13450 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
13451 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13452 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
13453 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13454 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
13455 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080013456 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
13457 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13458 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013459 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13460 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
13461 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13462 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
13463 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013464
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010013465 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
13466 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
13467 the corresponding match text.
13468
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013469 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
13470 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
13471 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
13472 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
13473 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013474
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013475 Example :
13476
13477 # this is a comment and is ignored
13478 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
13479 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
13480 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
13481 | | | `---------- value
13482 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
13483 | `---------------------------- key
13484 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
13485
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013486mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013487 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13488 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013489 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013490 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013491 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013492 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13493 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13494 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13495 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013496 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013497 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013498
13499mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013500 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020013501 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
13502 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013503 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013504 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013505 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013506 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13507 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13508 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13509 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013510 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013511 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013512
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010013513nbsrv
13514 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
13515 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13516 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13517 map lookup.
13518
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013519neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013520 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
13521 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
13522 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
13523 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013524
13525not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013526 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013527 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013528 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013529 absence of a flag).
13530
13531odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013532 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013533 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
13534
13535or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013536 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013537 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013538 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13539 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013540 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013541 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13542 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13543 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13544 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013545 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013546 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013547
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013548protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
13549 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
13550 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
13551 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
13552 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
13553 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
13554 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
13555 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
13556 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
13557 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
13558 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
13559 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
13560
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010013561regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013562 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
13563 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
13564 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
13565 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
13566 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
13567 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
13568 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
13569 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
13570 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
13571 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010013572 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
13573 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
13574 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
13575 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013576
13577 Example :
13578
13579 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
13580 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
13581 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
13582 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
13583
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013584capture-req(<id>)
13585 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
13586 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13587
13588 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013589 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13590 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013591
13592capture-res(<id>)
13593 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
13594 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13595
13596 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013597 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13598 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013599
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013600sdbm([<avalanche>])
13601 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
13602 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13603 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13604 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13605 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13606 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13607 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013608 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
13609 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013610
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013611set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013612 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
13613 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
13614 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013615 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013616 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13617 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013618 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013619 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13620 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013621 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013622 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013623
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013624sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020013625 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013626 sample with length of 20 bytes.
13627
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020013628sha2([<bits>])
13629 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
13630 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
13631
13632 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
13633 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
13634
13635 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
13636 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
13637
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020013638srv_queue
13639 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
13640 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
13641 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
13642 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
13643 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
13644
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020013645strcmp(<var>)
13646 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
13647 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
13648 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
13649 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
13650 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
13651 shorter).
13652
13653 Example :
13654
13655 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
13656 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
13657 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
13658
13659
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013660sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013661 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
13662 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013663 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013664 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
13665 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013666 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013667 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13668 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013669 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013670 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13671 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013672 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013673 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013674
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013675table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
13676 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13677 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13678 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
13679 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13680 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13681 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
13682
13683
13684table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
13685 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13686 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13687 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
13688 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13689 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13690 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
13691
13692table_conn_cnt(<table>)
13693 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13694 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013695 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013696 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
13697 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13698
13699table_conn_cur(<table>)
13700 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13701 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13702 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13703 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13704 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
13705
13706table_conn_rate(<table>)
13707 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13708 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13709 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
13710 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13711 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
13712
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013713table_gpt0(<table>)
13714 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13715 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
13716 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13717 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13718 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
13719
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013720table_gpc0(<table>)
13721 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13722 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13723 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13724 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13725 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
13726
13727table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
13728 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13729 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13730 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
13731 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13732 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
13733 sample fetch keyword.
13734
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013735table_gpc1(<table>)
13736 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13737 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13738 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
13739 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13740 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
13741
13742table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
13743 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13744 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13745 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
13746 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13747 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
13748 sample fetch keyword.
13749
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013750table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
13751 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13752 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013753 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013754 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13755 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13756
13757table_http_err_rate(<table>)
13758 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13759 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13760 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
13761 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
13762 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
13763 keyword.
13764
13765table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
13766 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13767 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013768 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013769 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
13770 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13771
13772table_http_req_rate(<table>)
13773 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13774 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13775 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
13776 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
13777 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
13778 keyword.
13779
13780table_kbytes_in(<table>)
13781 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13782 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013783 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013784 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13785 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13786 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
13787 keyword.
13788
13789table_kbytes_out(<table>)
13790 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13791 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013792 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013793 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13794 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13795 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
13796 keyword.
13797
13798table_server_id(<table>)
13799 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13800 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13801 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
13802 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
13803 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
13804 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
13805
13806table_sess_cnt(<table>)
13807 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13808 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013809 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013810 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
13811 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13812 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
13813 keyword.
13814
13815table_sess_rate(<table>)
13816 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13817 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13818 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
13819 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
13820 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13821 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
13822 keyword.
13823
13824table_trackers(<table>)
13825 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13826 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13827 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13828 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
13829 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
13830 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
13831 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
13832 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
13833 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
13834 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
13835
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013836upper
13837 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
13838 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13839 type. The result is of type string.
13840
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020013841url_dec
13842 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
13843 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
13844
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013845ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010013846 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013847 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
13848 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
13849 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013850 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
13851 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
13852 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
13853 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013854 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013855 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
13856 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010013857
13858 Example:
13859 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
13860 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
13861
13862 message Point {
13863 int32 latitude = 1;
13864 int32 longitude = 2;
13865 }
13866
13867 message PPoint {
13868 Point point = 59;
13869 }
13870
13871 message Rectangle {
13872 // One corner of the rectangle.
13873 PPoint lo = 48;
13874 // The other corner of the rectangle.
13875 PPoint hi = 49;
13876 }
13877
13878 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
13879 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
13880 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
13881
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013882 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
13883 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013884 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013885 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
13886
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013887 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013888
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013889 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013890
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013891 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013892 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
13893 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
13894
13895 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
13896 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
13897 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
13898
13899 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
13900 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
13901 interpret the previous binary sample.
13902
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010013903
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013904unset-var(<var name>)
13905 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
13906 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
13907 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
13908 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13909 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
13910 response),
13911 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13912 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
13913 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
13914 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
13915
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013916utime(<format>[,<offset>])
13917 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13918 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
13919 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13920 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13921 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13922 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
13923
13924 Example :
13925
13926 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013927 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013928 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13929
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013930word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13931 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
13932 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
13933 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
13934 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
13935 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
13936
13937 Example :
13938 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
13939 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13940 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
13941 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
13942 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010013943
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013944wt6([<avalanche>])
13945 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
13946 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13947 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13948 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13949 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13950 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13951 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013952 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
13953 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013954
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013955xor(<value>)
13956 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013957 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013958 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013959 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013960 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013961 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13962 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013963 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013964 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13965 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013966 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013967 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013968
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010013969xxh32([<seed>])
13970 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
13971 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13972 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13973 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13974 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13975 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13976 as cryptographically secure.
13977
13978xxh64([<seed>])
13979 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
13980 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13981 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13982 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13983 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13984 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13985 as cryptographically secure.
13986
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013987
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200139887.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013989--------------------------------------------
13990
13991A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
13992not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
13993"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
13994The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
13995
13996always_false : boolean
13997 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13998 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13999
14000always_true : boolean
14001 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14002 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14003
14004avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014005 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014006 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14007 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14008 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14009 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14010 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14011 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14012 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14013 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14014 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14015 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14016 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14017 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14018 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014019
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014020be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014021 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14022 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14023 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14024 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014025 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14026
14027be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14028 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14029 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14030 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14031 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14032 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014033 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14034 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014035
14036 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14037 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14038 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014039
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014040be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14041 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14042 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14043 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014044 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014045 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14046 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014047
14048 Example :
14049 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14050 backend dynamic
14051 mode http
14052 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14053 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014054
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014055bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014056 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14057 of the string.
14058
14059bool(<bool>) : bool
14060 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14061 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14062
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014063connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14064 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014065 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014066 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14067 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014068
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014069 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014070 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014071 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14072
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014073 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14074 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014075
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014076 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014077 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014078 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014079 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014080 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014081 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014082 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014083
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014084 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14085 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014086 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014087 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014088
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014089cpu_calls : integer
14090 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14091 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14092 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14093 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14094 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14095 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14096
14097cpu_ns_avg : integer
14098 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14099 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14100 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14101 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14102 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14103 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14104 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14105 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14106 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14107 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14108 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14109
14110cpu_ns_tot : integer
14111 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14112 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14113 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14114 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14115 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14116 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14117 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14118 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14119 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14120 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14121 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14122 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14123 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14124
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014125date([<offset>]) : integer
14126 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
14127 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
14128 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
14129 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014130 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14131
14132 Example :
14133
14134 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14135 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014136
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014137date_us : integer
14138 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14139 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14140 from the same timeval structure.
14141
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014142distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14143 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14144 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14145 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14146 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14147 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14148 list of supported tokens.
14149
14150distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14151 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14152 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14153 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14154 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14155 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14156 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14157 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14158 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14159 supported tokens.
14160
14161 Example :
14162 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14163 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14164 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14165 # send large files to the big farm
14166 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14167
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014168env(<name>) : string
14169 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14170 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14171 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14172 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14173 certain way.
14174
14175 Examples :
14176 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14177 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14178
14179 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14180 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014182fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14183 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014184 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14185 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014186 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14187 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014188 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014189 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14190 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014191
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014192fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14193 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14194 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14195 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14196
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014197fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14198 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14199 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14200 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14201 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14202 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14203 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14204 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14205 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014206
14207 Example :
14208 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14209 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14210 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14211 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14212 frontend mail
14213 bind :25
14214 mode tcp
14215 maxconn 100
14216 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14217 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14218 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14219 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014220
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014221hostname : string
14222 Returns the system hostname.
14223
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014224int(<integer>) : signed integer
14225 Returns a signed integer.
14226
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014227ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14228 Returns an ipv4.
14229
14230ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14231 Returns an ipv6.
14232
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014233lat_ns_avg : integer
14234 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14235 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14236 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14237 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14238 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14239 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14240 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14241 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14242 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14243 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14244 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14245 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14246 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14247 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14248
14249lat_ns_tot : integer
14250 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14251 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14252 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14253 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14254 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14255 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14256 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14257 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14258 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14259 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14260 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14261 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14262 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14263 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14264 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14265 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14266 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14267 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14268 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14269
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014270meth(<method>) : method
14271 Returns a method.
14272
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014273nbproc : integer
14274 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14275 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14276 and debugging purposes.
14277
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014278nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14279 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14280 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14281 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014282 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14283 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14284 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014285
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014286prio_class : integer
14287 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14288 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14289 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14290
14291prio_offset : integer
14292 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14293 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14294 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14295 set-priority-offset".
14296
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014297proc : integer
14298 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14299 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14300 debugging purposes.
14301
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014302queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014303 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14304 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14305 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014306 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14307 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14308 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14309 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14310 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
14311
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010014312rand([<range>]) : integer
14313 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
14314 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
14315 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
14316 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
14317 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
14318
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020014319uuid([<version>]) : string
14320 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
14321 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
14322 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
14323
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014324srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14325 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14326 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
14327 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
14328 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
14329 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014330 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
14331 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
14332
14333srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14334 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14335 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
14336 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14337 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
14338 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
14339 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
14340 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
14341
14342 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
14343 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014344
14345srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
14346 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
14347 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
14348 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014349 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014350 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
14351 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
14352 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
14353
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020014354srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14355 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
14356 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14357 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
14358 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
14359 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
14360 fetch methods.
14361
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014362srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14363 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14364 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014365 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014366 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
14367 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014368 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014369 overloading servers).
14370
14371 Example :
14372 # Redirect to a separate back
14373 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
14374 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
14375 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
14376
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014377stopping : boolean
14378 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
14379 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
14380 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
14381
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014382str(<string>) : string
14383 Returns a string.
14384
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014385table_avl([<table>]) : integer
14386 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
14387 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
14388
14389table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14390 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
14391 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
14392 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
14393
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010014394thread : integer
14395 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
14396 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
14397 and debugging purposes.
14398
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014399var(<var-name>) : undefined
14400 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014401 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
14402 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014403 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014404 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14405 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014406 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014407 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14408 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014409 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014410 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014411
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200144127.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014413----------------------------------
14414
14415The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
14416closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
14417methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
14418sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
14419TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014420the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
14421counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020014422"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
14423used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
14424can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
14425Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
14426table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
14427tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
14428currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014429
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010014430bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010014431 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14432 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14433 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
14434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014435be_id : integer
14436 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
14437 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14438
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014439be_name : string
14440 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
14441 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14442
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014443dst : ip
14444 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
14445 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
14446 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
14447 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014448 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
14449 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
14450 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
14451 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
14452 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
14453 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014454
14455dst_conn : integer
14456 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14457 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
14458 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
14459 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
14460 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
14461 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
14462 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
14463 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014464
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014465dst_is_local : boolean
14466 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
14467 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
14468 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
14469 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014470 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014471 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
14472 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
14473 it only once per connection.
14474
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014475dst_port : integer
14476 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
14477 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
14478 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
14479 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
14480 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
14481 an HTTP header.
14482
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020014483fc_http_major : integer
14484 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14485 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14486 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
14487
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020014488fc_pp_authority : string
14489 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
14490 if any.
14491
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010014492fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
14493 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
14494 header.
14495
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020014496fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
14497 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
14498 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
14499 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
14500 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14501 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14502 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14503
14504fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
14505 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
14506 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
14507 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
14508 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14509 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14510 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14511
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014512fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
14513 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14514 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14515 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14516 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14517
14518fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
14519 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14520 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14521 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14522 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14523
14524fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
14525 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
14526 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14527 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14528 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14529
14530fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
14531 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
14532 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14533 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14534 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14535
14536fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
14537 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
14538 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14539 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14540 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14541
14542fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
14543 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
14544 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14545 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14546 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14547
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020014548fe_defbe : string
14549 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
14550 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
14551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014552fe_id : integer
14553 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010014554 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014555 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14556
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014557fe_name : string
14558 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
14559 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
14560 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14561
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014562sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014563sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14564sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14565sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014566 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
14567 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14568 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
14569
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014570sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014571sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14572sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14573sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014574 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
14575 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14576 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
14577
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014578sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014579sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14580sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14581sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014582 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14583 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014584 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14585 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14586 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014587
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014588 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014589 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14590 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014591 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14592 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
14593 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014594 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14595 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14596
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014597sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14598sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14599sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14600sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14601 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14602 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
14603 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14604 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14605 when a first ACL was verified.
14606
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014607sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014608sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14609sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14610sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014611 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014612 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
14613
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014614sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014615sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14616sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14617sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014618 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14619 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
14620 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
14621
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014622sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014623sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14624sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14625sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014626 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
14627 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
14628 See also src_conn_rate.
14629
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014630sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014631sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14632sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14633sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014634 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014635 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014636
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014637sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14638sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14639sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14640sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14641 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14642 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14643
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014644sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14645sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14646sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14647sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14648 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14649 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
14650
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014651sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014652sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14653sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14654sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014655 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
14656 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14657 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014658 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14659 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14660 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014661
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014662sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14663sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14664sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14665sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14666 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14667 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14668 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14669 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14670 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14671 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14672
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014673sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014674sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14675sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14676sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014677 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014678 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
14679 See also src_http_err_cnt.
14680
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014681sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014682sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14683sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14684sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014685 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
14686 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14687 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
14688 src_http_err_rate.
14689
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014690sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014691sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14692sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14693sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014694 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014695 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14696 src_http_req_cnt.
14697
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014698sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014699sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14700sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14701sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014702 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
14703 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
14704 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14705 src_http_req_rate.
14706
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014707sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014708sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14709sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14710sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014711 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014712 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14713 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14714 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14715 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014716
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014717 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014718 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14719 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014720 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14721
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014722sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14723sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14724sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14725sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14726 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
14727 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14728 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14729 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14730 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
14731
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014732sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014733sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14734sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14735sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014736 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
14737 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14738 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014739
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014740sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014741sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14742sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14743sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014744 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
14745 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14746 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014747
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014748sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014749sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14750sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14751sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014752 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014753 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
14754 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
14755 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014756 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014757 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
14758
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014759sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014760sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14761sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14762sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014763 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
14764 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14765 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
14766 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
14767 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014768 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014769
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014770sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014771sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14772sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14773sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020014774 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
14775 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
14776 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
14777
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014778sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014779sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14780sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14781sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014782 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14783 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014784 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014785 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
14786 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014787 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
14788 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
14789 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014790
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014791so_id : integer
14792 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
14793 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
14794 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014795
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014796src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014797 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014798 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
14799 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
14800 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014801 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
14802 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
14803 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014804 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
14805 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
14806 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
14807 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
14808 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
14809 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
14810 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014811
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014812 Example:
14813 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
14814 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
14815
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014816src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14817 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
14818 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
14819 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014820 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014822src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14823 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
14824 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014825 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014826 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014828src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14829 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14830 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14831 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14832 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14833 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14834 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014835
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014836 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014837 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14838 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
14839 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
14840 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014841 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014842 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14843 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14844
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014845src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14846 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14847 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14848 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14849 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14850 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14851 was verified.
14852
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014853src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014854 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014855 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014856 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014857 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014858
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014859src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014860 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014861 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14862 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014863 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014865src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14866 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
14867 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14868 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014869 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014871src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014872 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014873 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014874 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014875 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014876
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014877src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14878 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14879 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14880 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14881 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
14882
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014883src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14884 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14885 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14886 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14887 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
14888
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014889src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014890 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014891 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014892 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14893 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014894 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14895 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14896 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014897
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014898src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14899 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14900 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14901 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14902 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14903 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14904 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14905 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14906
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014907src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014908 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014909 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014910 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014911 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014912 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014914src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14915 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
14916 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14917 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14918 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014919 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014921src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014922 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014923 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14924 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014925 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014926
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014927src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14928 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
14929 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14930 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014931 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014932 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014933
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014934src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14935 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14936 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14937 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014938 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014939 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
14940 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014941
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014942 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014943 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014944 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014945 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014946
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014947src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14948 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14949 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14950 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
14951 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14952 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
14953 connection when a first ACL was verified.
14954
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014955src_is_local : boolean
14956 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
14957 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
14958 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
14959 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014960 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014961 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
14962 once per connection.
14963
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014964src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014965 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
14966 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
14967 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
14968 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
14969 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014970
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014971src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014972 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
14973 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14974 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
14975 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
14976 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014977
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014978src_port : integer
14979 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
14980 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
14981 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
14982 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014983
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014984src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014985 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014986 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14987 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
14988 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014989 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014990
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014991src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14992 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
14993 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14994 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14995 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014996 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014998src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14999 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15000 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15001 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15002 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15003 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15004 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15005 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15006 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015007
15008 Example :
15009 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15010 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15011 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15012 listen ssh
15013 bind :22
15014 mode tcp
15015 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015016 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015017 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015018 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15019
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015020srv_id : integer
15021 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15022 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15023 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015024
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200150257.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015026----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015027
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015028The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15029closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15030when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15031usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015032future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015033
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001503451d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15035 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15036 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15037 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15038 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15039 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15040
15041 Example :
15042 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15043 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15044 # the request.
15045 frontend http-in
15046 bind *:8081
15047 default_backend servers
15048 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15049 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15050
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015051ssl_bc : boolean
15052 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15053 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15054 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15055
15056ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15057 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15058 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15059
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015060ssl_bc_alpn : string
15061 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15062 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015063 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015064 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15065 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15066 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15067 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15068 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15069 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15070
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015071ssl_bc_cipher : string
15072 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15073 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15074
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015075ssl_bc_client_random : binary
15076 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15077 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15078 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15079
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015080ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15081 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15082 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15083 session or a TLS ticket.
15084
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015085ssl_bc_npn : string
15086 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15087 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015088 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015089 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15090 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15091 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15092 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15093 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15094
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015095ssl_bc_protocol : string
15096 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15097 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15098
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015099ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015100 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015101 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15102 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015103
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015104ssl_bc_server_random : binary
15105 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15106 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15107 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15108
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015109ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15110 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15111 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15112 if session was reused or not.
15113
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015114ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15115 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15116 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15117 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15118 BoringSSL.
15119
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015120ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15121 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15122 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15123
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015124ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15125 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15126 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15127 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15128 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15129 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015130
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015131ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15132 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15133 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15134 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15135 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015136
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015137ssl_c_der : binary
15138 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15139 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15140 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15141
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015142ssl_c_err : integer
15143 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15144 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15145 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15146 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15147 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015148
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015149ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15150 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15151 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15152 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15153 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15154 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15155 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15156 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15157 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015159ssl_c_key_alg : string
15160 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15161 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15162 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015164ssl_c_notafter : string
15165 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15166 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15167 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015168
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015169ssl_c_notbefore : string
15170 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15171 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15172 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015173
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015174ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15175 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15176 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15177 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15178 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15179 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15180 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15181 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15182 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015183
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015184ssl_c_serial : binary
15185 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15186 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15187 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015189ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15190 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15191 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15192 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015193 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15194 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15195
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015196 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015197 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015198
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015199ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15200 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15201 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15202 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015203
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015204ssl_c_used : boolean
15205 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15206 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015208ssl_c_verify : integer
15209 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15210 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15211 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15212 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015214ssl_c_version : integer
15215 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15216 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015217
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015218ssl_f_der : binary
15219 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15220 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15221 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015223ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15224 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15225 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15226 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15227 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015228 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015229 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15230 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15231 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015232
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015233ssl_f_key_alg : string
15234 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15235 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15236 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015237
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015238ssl_f_notafter : string
15239 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15240 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15241 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015242
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015243ssl_f_notbefore : string
15244 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15245 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15246 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015247
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015248ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15249 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15250 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15251 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15252 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15253 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15254 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15255 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15256 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015258ssl_f_serial : binary
15259 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15260 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15261 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015262
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015263ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15264 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15265 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15266 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15267
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015268ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15269 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15270 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15271 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015272
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015273ssl_f_version : integer
15274 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15275 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15276
15277ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015278 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15279 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15280 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15281
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015282 Example :
15283 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15284 listen http-https
15285 bind :80
15286 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15287 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15288
15289ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15290 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15291 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15292
15293ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015294 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015295 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15296 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15297 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15298 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15299 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15300 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15301 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15302 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015304ssl_fc_cipher : string
15305 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15306 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015307
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015308ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
15309 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
15310 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015311 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015312
15313ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
15314 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
15315 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015316 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015317
15318ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
15319 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
15320 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
15321 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015322 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020015323 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015324
15325ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
15326 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
15327 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015328 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015329
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015330ssl_fc_client_random : binary
15331 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15332 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15333 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15334
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015335ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015336 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
15337 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010015338 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
15339 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
15340 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
15341 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015342
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020015343ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
15344 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
15345 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
15346 wait until the handshake happened.
15347
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015348ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
15349 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015350 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
15351 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015352 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015353 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015354
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020015355ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015356 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010015357 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
15358 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015359
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015360ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015361 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015362 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
15363 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
15364 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15365 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
15366 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
15367 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
15368 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020015369
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015370ssl_fc_protocol : string
15371 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
15372 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015373
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015374ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015375 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015376 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15377 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015378
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015379ssl_fc_server_random : binary
15380 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15381 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15382 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15383
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015384ssl_fc_session_id : binary
15385 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
15386 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
15387 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
15388 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015389
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015390ssl_fc_session_key : binary
15391 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
15392 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15393 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15394 BoringSSL.
15395
15396
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015397ssl_fc_sni : string
15398 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
15399 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
15400 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
15401 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
15402 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
15403
15404 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
15405 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
15406 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015407 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020015408 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015409
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015410 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015411 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
15412 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020015413
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015414ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
15415 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
15416 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015417
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015418
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200154197.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015420------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015421
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015422Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
15423sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
15424only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
15425For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
15426be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
15427can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
15428sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
15429for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
15430content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015431
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015432payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015433 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015434 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
15435 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015437payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
15438 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015439 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015440 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015441
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020015442req.hdrs : string
15443 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
15444 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
15445 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
15446 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
15447
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020015448req.hdrs_bin : binary
15449 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
15450 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
15451 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
15452 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
15453 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
15454 names and values (length of 0 for both).
15455
15456 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
15457
15458 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
15459 str: <int:length><bytes>
15460
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015461req.len : integer
15462req_len : integer (deprecated)
15463 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15464 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15465 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15466 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15467 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15468 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15469 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
15470 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015471
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015472req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15473 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015474 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15475 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15476 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15477 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015479 ACL alternatives :
15480 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015481
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015482req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15483 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15484 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15485 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
15486 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015488 ACL alternatives :
15489 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015490
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015491 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015492
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015493req.proto_http : boolean
15494req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
15495 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
15496 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
15497 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
15498 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
15499 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
15500 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
15501 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015503 Example:
15504 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
15505 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15506 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015507 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015508
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015509req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
15510rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15511 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
15512 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
15513 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
15514 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
15515 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
15516 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
15517 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015518
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015519 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
15520 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
15521 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
15522 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
15523 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
15524 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015526 ACL derivatives :
15527 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015528
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015529 Example :
15530 listen tse-farm
15531 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
15532 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
15533 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15534 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
15535 # apply RDP cookie persistence
15536 persist rdp-cookie
15537 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
15538 # This is only useful makes sense if
15539 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
15540 stick-table type string size 204800
15541 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
15542 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
15543 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015545 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
15546 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015547
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015548req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
15549rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
15550 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
15551 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
15552 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
15553 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015555 ACL derivatives :
15556 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015557
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015558req.ssl_alpn : string
15559 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
15560 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
15561 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
15562 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
15563 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
15564 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015565 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015566
15567 Examples :
15568 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15569 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15570 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015571 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015572 default_backend bk_default
15573
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015574req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
15575 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
15576 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015577 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
15578 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
15579 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
15580 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
15581 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015583req.ssl_hello_type : integer
15584req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15585 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15586 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
15587 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15588 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15589 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
15590 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15591 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015593req.ssl_sni : string
15594req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
15595 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
15596 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
15597 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
15598 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15599 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15600 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
15601 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
15602 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
15603 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
15604 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
15605 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
15606 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015607
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015608 ACL derivatives :
15609 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015610
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015611 Examples :
15612 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15613 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15614 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
15615 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
15616 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015617
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053015618req.ssl_st_ext : integer
15619 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
15620 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
15621 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
15622 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
15623 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
15624 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
15625 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
15626 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
15627 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
15628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015629req.ssl_ver : integer
15630req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
15631 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
15632 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
15633 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
15634 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
15635 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15636 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15637 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015638 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015639 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015641 ACL derivatives :
15642 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015643
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020015644res.len : integer
15645 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15646 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15647 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15648 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15649 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15650 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15651 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
15652 content inspection.
15653
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015654res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15655 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015656 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15657 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15658 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15659 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015660
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015661res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15662 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15663 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15664 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
15665 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015666
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015667 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015668
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020015669res.ssl_hello_type : integer
15670rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15671 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15672 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
15673 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15674 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15675 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
15676 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15677 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
15678
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015679wait_end : boolean
15680 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
15681 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015682 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015683 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
15684 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015685 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015686 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
15687 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015688
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015689 Examples :
15690 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
15691 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
15692 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015694 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
15695 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15696 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
15697 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
15698 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
15699 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
15700 tcp-request content reject
15701
15702
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200157037.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015704--------------------------------------
15705
15706It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
15707This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
15708data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
15709its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
15710HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
15711content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
15712to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
15713more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
15714response are indexed.
15715
15716base : string
15717 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
15718 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
15719 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
15720 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
15721 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
15722 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
15723 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
15724 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
15725
15726 ACL derivatives :
15727 base : exact string match
15728 base_beg : prefix match
15729 base_dir : subdir match
15730 base_dom : domain match
15731 base_end : suffix match
15732 base_len : length match
15733 base_reg : regex match
15734 base_sub : substring match
15735
15736base32 : integer
15737 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
15738 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
15739 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015740 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
15741 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
15742 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015743
15744base32+src : binary
15745 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
15746 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
15747 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
15748 per-URL counters.
15749
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015750capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
15751 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
15752 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15753 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
15754
15755capture.req.method : string
15756 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
15757 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
15758 because it's allocated.
15759
15760capture.req.uri : string
15761 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
15762 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
15763 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
15764 allocated.
15765
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015766capture.req.ver : string
15767 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15768 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
15769 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
15770
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015771capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
15772 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
15773 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15774 The first entry is an index of 0.
15775 See also: "capture response header"
15776
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015777capture.res.ver : string
15778 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15779 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
15780 persistent flag.
15781
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015782req.body : binary
15783 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
15784 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15785 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
15786 the first chunk is analyzed.
15787
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020015788req.body_param([<name>) : string
15789 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
15790 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
15791 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
15792 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
15793 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
15794 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
15795 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
15796 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
15797 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
15798 given.
15799
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015800req.body_len : integer
15801 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
15802 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
15803 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15804 "option http-buffer-request".
15805
15806req.body_size : integer
15807 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
15808 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
15809 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
15810 that the request body has been buffered made available using
15811 "option http-buffer-request".
15812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015813req.cook([<name>]) : string
15814cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15815 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15816 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
15817 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
15818 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
15819 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
15820 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
15821 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
15822 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
15823
15824 ACL derivatives :
15825 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
15826 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
15827 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
15828 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
15829 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
15830 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
15831 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
15832 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015833
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015834req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15835cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15836 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
15837 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015838
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015839req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
15840cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15841 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15842 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
15843 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
15844 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015845
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015846cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15847 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15848 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
15849 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
15850 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020015851 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015852 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
15853 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
15854 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
15855 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015856
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015857hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15858 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
15859 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
15860 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
15861 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015862 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015863
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015864req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
15865 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15866 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15867 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15868 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15869 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15870 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
15871 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
15872 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015873
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015874req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15875 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15876 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15877 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
15878 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015879
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015880req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15881 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15882 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15883 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15884 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15885 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15886 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
15887 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
15888 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000015889 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015890 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015891 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015892
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015893 ACL derivatives :
15894 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
15895 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
15896 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
15897 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
15898 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
15899 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
15900 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
15901 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
15902
15903req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15904hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
15905 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15906 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
15907 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
15908 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
15909 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
15910 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
15911 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
15912 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
15913 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
15914
15915req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
15916hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
15917 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
15918 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
15919 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
15920 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
15921 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015922 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015923 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
15924 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
15925
15926req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
15927hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
15928 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
15929 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
15930 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
15931 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15932 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15933 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15934 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
15935
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010015936
15937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015938http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
15939 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
15940 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
15941 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
15942 basic auth is supported.
15943
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010015944http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
15945 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
15946 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
15947 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
15948 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015949 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
15950 basic auth is supported.
15951
15952 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010015953 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
15954 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
15955 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
15956 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015957
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020015958http_auth_pass : string
15959 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
15960 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
15961 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
15962
15963http_auth_type : string
15964 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
15965 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
15966 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
15967
15968http_auth_user : string
15969 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
15970 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
15971 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
15972
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015973http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020015974 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
15975 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015976 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
15977 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020015978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015979method : integer + string
15980 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
15981 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
15982 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
15983 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
15984 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
15985 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
15986 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015988 ACL derivatives :
15989 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015990
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015991 Example :
15992 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
15993 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
15994 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015995
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015996path : string
15997 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
15998 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
15999 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16000 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16001 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016002 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016003 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016004
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016005 ACL derivatives :
16006 path : exact string match
16007 path_beg : prefix match
16008 path_dir : subdir match
16009 path_dom : domain match
16010 path_end : suffix match
16011 path_len : length match
16012 path_reg : regex match
16013 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016014
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016015query : string
16016 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16017 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16018 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16019 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016020 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016021 which stops before the question mark.
16022
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016023req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16024 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16025 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16026 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16027 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16028
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016029req.ver : string
16030req_ver : string (deprecated)
16031 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16032 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16033 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016034
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016035 ACL derivatives :
16036 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016037
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016038res.comp : boolean
16039 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16040 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16041 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016042
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016043res.comp_algo : string
16044 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16045 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16046 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016047
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016048res.cook([<name>]) : string
16049scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16050 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16051 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16052 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016053
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016054 ACL derivatives :
16055 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016056
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016057res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16058scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16059 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16060 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16061 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016062
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016063res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16064scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16065 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16066 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16067 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016068
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016069res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16070 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16071 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16072 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16073 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16074 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16075 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16076 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16077 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16078 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016080res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16081 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16082 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16083 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16084 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16085 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016087res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16088shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16089 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16090 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16091 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16092 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16093 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16094 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16095 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16096 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016097
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016098 ACL derivatives :
16099 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16100 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16101 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16102 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16103 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16104 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16105 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16106 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16107
16108res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16109shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16110 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16111 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16112 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16113 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16114 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016115
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016116res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16117shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16118 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16119 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16120 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16121 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16122 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16123 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016124
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016125res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16126 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16127 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16128 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16129 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16130
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016131res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16132shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16133 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16134 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16135 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16136 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16137 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16138 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016139
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016140res.ver : string
16141resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16142 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16143 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016144
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016145 ACL derivatives :
16146 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016148set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16149 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16150 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016151 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016152 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016153
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016154 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16155 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016156
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016157status : integer
16158 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16159 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16160 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016161
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016162unique-id : string
16163 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16164 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16165 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16166 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16167 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16168 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16169
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016170url : string
16171 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16172 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16173 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16174 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16175 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16176 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16177 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016178
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016179 ACL derivatives :
16180 url : exact string match
16181 url_beg : prefix match
16182 url_dir : subdir match
16183 url_dom : domain match
16184 url_end : suffix match
16185 url_len : length match
16186 url_reg : regex match
16187 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016189url_ip : ip
16190 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16191 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16192 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16193 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16194 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16195 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16196 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016197
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016198url_port : integer
16199 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16200 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16201 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16202 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016203
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016204urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16205url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016206 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16207 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016208 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16209 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16210 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16211 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016212 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16213 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016214 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16215 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016217 ACL derivatives :
16218 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16219 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16220 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16221 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16222 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16223 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16224 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16225 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016226
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016227
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016228 Example :
16229 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16230 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16231 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16232 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016233
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016234urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016235 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16236 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16237 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016238
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016239url32 : integer
16240 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16241 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16242 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16243 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16244 is an unsigned integer.
16245
16246url32+src : binary
16247 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16248 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16249 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16250
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200162527.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016253---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016254
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016255Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16256every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016257order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016258
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016259ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16260---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016261FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016262HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016263HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16264HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016265HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16266HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16267HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16268HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16269LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016270METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016271METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016272METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16273METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16274METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16275METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016276METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016277METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016278RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016279REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016280TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016281WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
16282---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016283
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010016284
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162858. Logging
16286----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016287
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016288One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
16289provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
16290very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
16291provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
16292state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016293to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016294headers.
16295
16296In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
16297about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
16298send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
16299
16300 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
16301 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
16302 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
16303 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
16304 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016305 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060016306 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016307
16308The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
16309allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
16310as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
16311while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
16312real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
16313delay.
16314
16315
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163168.1. Log levels
16317---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016318
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016319TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016320source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016321HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
16322in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
16323track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
16324syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
16325about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016326
16327
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163288.2. Log formats
16329----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016330
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016331HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016332and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
16333slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
16334options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016335
16336 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
16337 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
16338 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
16339 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
16340 extents.
16341
16342 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
16343 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
16344 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
16345 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
16346 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
16347
16348 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
16349 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
16350 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
16351 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
16352 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
16353
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020016354 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
16355 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
16356 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
16357 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
16358
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016359 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
16360
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016361Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
16362specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
16363field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
16364servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
16365always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
16366identifier.
16367
16368Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
16369 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
16370 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
16371 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
16372 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
16373
16374
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163758.2.1. Default log format
16376-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016377
16378This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
16379as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
16380format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
16381
16382 Example :
16383 listen www
16384 mode http
16385 log global
16386 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16387
16388 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
16389 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
16390 (www/HTTP)
16391
16392 Field Format Extract from the example above
16393 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
16394 2 'Connect from' Connect from
16395 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
16396 4 'to' to
16397 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
16398 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
16399
16400Detailed fields description :
16401 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
16402 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
16403 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
16404 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
16405 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16406 and processed the connection.
16407 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
16408
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016409In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
16410"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
16411connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
16412
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016413It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
16414will eventually disappear.
16415
16416
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164178.2.2. TCP log format
16418---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016419
16420The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
16421is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
16422information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
16423counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
16424emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
16425environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
16426the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
16427sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016428specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
16429not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
16430fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
16431marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016432
16433 Example :
16434 frontend fnt
16435 mode tcp
16436 option tcplog
16437 log global
16438 default_backend bck
16439
16440 backend bck
16441 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16442
16443 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
16444 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
16445 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
16446
16447 Field Format Extract from the example above
16448 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
16449 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
16450 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
16451 4 frontend_name fnt
16452 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
16453 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
16454 7 bytes_read* 212
16455 8 termination_state --
16456 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
16457 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16458
16459Detailed fields description :
16460 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016461 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16462 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16463 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016464 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016465 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016466 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016467
16468 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016469 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16470 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16471 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016472
16473 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
16474 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
16475 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016476 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
16477 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
16478 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
16479 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016480
16481 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16482 and processed the connection.
16483
16484 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16485 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16486 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
16487 applications.
16488
16489 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16490 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16491 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16492 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
16493 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
16494
16495 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16496 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
16497 See "Timers" below for more details.
16498
16499 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16500 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
16501 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
16502 "Timers" below for more details.
16503
16504 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016505 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016506 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
16507 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
16508 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
16509 details.
16510
16511 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
16512 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
16513 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
16514 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
16515 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
16516
16517 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16518 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16519 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
16520 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
16521 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
16522 for more details.
16523
16524 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016525 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016526 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
16527 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
16528 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016529 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016530
16531 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16532 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16533 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16534 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16535 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16536 caused by a denial of service attack.
16537
16538 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16539 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16540 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16541 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16542 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16543 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16544 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16545 denial of service attack.
16546
16547 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16548 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16549 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16550 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16551 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16552 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16553 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16554 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
16555 be processed than on other servers.
16556
16557 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16558 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16559 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16560 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16561 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16562 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16563 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16564 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16565 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16566 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16567 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16568 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16569 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16570
16571 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16572 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16573 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16574 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16575 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16576 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016577 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016578 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16579
16580 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16581 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16582 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16583 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16584 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16585 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016586 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016587 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16588 occurs.
16589
16590
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165918.2.3. HTTP log format
16592----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016593
16594The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
16595is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
16596the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
16597are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
16598emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
16599generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
16600"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
16601which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016602frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
16603is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016604
16605Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
16606slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
16607with a star ('*') after the field name below.
16608
16609 Example :
16610 frontend http-in
16611 mode http
16612 option httplog
16613 log global
16614 default_backend bck
16615
16616 backend static
16617 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16618
16619 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
16620 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
16621 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016622 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016623
16624 Field Format Extract from the example above
16625 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
16626 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016627 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016628 4 frontend_name http-in
16629 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016630 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016631 7 status_code 200
16632 8 bytes_read* 2750
16633 9 captured_request_cookie -
16634 10 captured_response_cookie -
16635 11 termination_state ----
16636 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
16637 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16638 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
16639 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
16640 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016641
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016642Detailed fields description :
16643 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016644 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16645 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16646 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016647 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016648 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016649 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016650
16651 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016652 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16653 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16654 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016655
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016656 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
16657 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016658
16659 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16660 and processed the connection.
16661
16662 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16663 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16664 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
16665
16666 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16667 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16668 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16669 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
16670 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
16671 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
16672
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016673 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
16674 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
16675 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016676 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016677 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
16678 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016679 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
16680 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016681
16682 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16683 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016684 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016685
16686 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16687 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016688 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
16689 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016690
16691 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
16692 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
16693 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
16694 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
16695 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016696 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
16697 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016698
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016699 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
16700 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
16701 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
16702 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
16703 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
16704 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
16705 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016706 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016707
16708 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
16709 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
16710 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
16711
16712 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
16713 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016714 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016715 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
16716 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
16717 overflowing.
16718
16719 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
16720 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
16721 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
16722 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
16723 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
16724 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
16725 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
16726 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16727
16728 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
16729 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
16730 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
16731 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
16732 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
16733 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
16734 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
16735 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16736
16737 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16738 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16739 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
16740 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
16741 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
16742 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
16743 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
16744
16745 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016746 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016747 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
16748 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
16749 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016750 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016751 system.
16752
16753 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16754 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16755 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16756 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16757 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16758 caused by a denial of service attack.
16759
16760 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16761 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16762 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16763 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16764 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16765 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16766 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16767 denial of service attack.
16768
16769 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16770 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16771 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16772 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16773 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16774 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16775 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16776 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
16777 processed than on other servers.
16778
16779 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16780 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16781 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16782 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16783 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16784 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16785 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16786 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16787 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16788 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16789 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16790 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16791 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16792
16793 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16794 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16795 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16796 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16797 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16798 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016799 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016800 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16801
16802 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16803 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16804 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16805 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16806 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16807 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016808 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016809 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16810 occurs.
16811
16812 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
16813 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
16814 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
16815 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
16816 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
16817 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
16818 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
16819 cookies" below for more details.
16820
16821 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
16822 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
16823 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
16824 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
16825 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
16826 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
16827 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
16828 and cookies" below for more details.
16829
16830 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
16831 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
16832 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
16833 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
16834 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
16835 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
16836 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
16837 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
16838
16839
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200168408.2.4. Custom log format
16841------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016842
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016843The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016844mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016845
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016846HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016847Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
16848separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
16849prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
16850
16851Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
16852variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016853("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016854
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016855If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020016856as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016857less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
16858the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
16859
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016860Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016861In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010016862in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016863
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016864Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
16865'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
16866https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
16867such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
16868
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016869Flags are :
16870 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016871 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016872 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
16873 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016874
16875 Example:
16876
16877 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
16878 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
16879
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016880 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
16881
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016882At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
16883
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016884 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
16885 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016886
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016887the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016888
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016889 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
16890 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
16891 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016892
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016893and the default TCP format is defined this way :
16894
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016895 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
16896 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016897
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016898Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
16899
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016900 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016901 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016902 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
16903 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
16904 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016905 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
16906 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
16907 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016908 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016909 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
16910 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000016911 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016912 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
16913 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010016914 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020016915 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016916 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016917 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016918 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020016919 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080016920 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016921 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
16922 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
16923 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
16924 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
16925 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016926 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016927 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
16928 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016929 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016930 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
16931 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016932 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16933 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
16934 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016935 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016936 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
16937 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016938 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016939 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16940 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
16941 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020016942 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020016943 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020016944 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
16945 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
16946 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
16947 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020016948 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016949 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016950 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016951 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010016952 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016953 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016954 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
16955 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
16956 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016957 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016958 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
16959 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016960 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016961 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
16962 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020016963 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016964 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016965 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016966 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016967
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016968 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016969
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010016970
169718.2.5. Error log format
16972-----------------------
16973
16974When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
16975protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
16976By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
16977"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016978will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010016979logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
16980
16981The format looks like this :
16982
16983 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
16984 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
16985 Connection error during SSL handshake
16986
16987 Field Format Extract from the example above
16988 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
16989 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
16990 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
16991 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
16992 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
16993
16994These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
16995failures.
16996
16997
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169988.3. Advanced logging options
16999-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017000
17001Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17002just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17003options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17004for more information about their usage.
17005
17006
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170078.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17008------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017009
17010It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17011haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17012commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17013monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17014ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17015
17016 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17017 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17018 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17019 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17020
17021 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17022 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17023 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017024 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017025 such as other load-balancers.
17026
17027 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17028 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17029 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17030
17031
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170328.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17033----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017034
17035The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17036what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17037or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017038"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017039just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17040log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17041after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17042is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17043with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17044with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17045
17046
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170478.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17048------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017049
17050Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17051for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17052"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17053retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17054raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17055a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17056file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17057you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17058"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17059
17060
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170618.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17062--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017063
17064Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17065multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17066them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17067"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17068logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17069error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17070and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17071too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17072useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17073alternative.
17074
17075
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170768.4. Timing events
17077------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017078
17079Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17080reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17081the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17082frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017083mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17084addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17085
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017086Timings events in HTTP mode:
17087
17088 first request 2nd request
17089 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17090 t tr t tr ...
17091 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17092 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17093 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17094 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17095 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17096
17097Timings events in TCP mode:
17098
17099 TCP session
17100 |<----------------->|
17101 t t
17102 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17103 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17104 |<------ Tt ------->|
17105
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017106 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017107 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017108 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17109 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17110 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017111 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017112 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17113 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17114 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17115 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017116
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017117 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17118 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17119 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017120 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17121 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17122 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17123 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17124 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17125 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017126
17127 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17128 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17129 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17130 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17131 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17132 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17133 request typed by hand during a test.
17134
17135 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17136 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017137 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017138 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17139 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17140 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17141 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017142
17143 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17144 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17145 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17146 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17147 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17148
17149 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17150 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17151 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17152 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17153 connection never established.
17154
17155 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17156 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17157 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17158 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17159 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17160 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17161 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17162 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17163 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17164 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17165 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17166
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017167 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17168 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17169 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17170 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17171 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17172 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17173
17174 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17175
17176 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17177 "Ta" can never be negative.
17178
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017179 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17180 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017181 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17182 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017183 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017184
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017185 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017186
17187 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017188 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17189 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017190
17191These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17192protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17193that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017194due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17195"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17196that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017197
17198Most common cases :
17199
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017200 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17201 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17202 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17203 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17204 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17205 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17206 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17207 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17208 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17209 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17210 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017211 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017212
17213 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17214 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17215 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17216 of ms on remote networks.
17217
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017218 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17219 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17220 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017221
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017222 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17223 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17224 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17225 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17226 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17227 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17228 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17229 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17230 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017231
17232Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17233
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017234 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017235 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017236 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017237
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017238 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017239 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17240 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17241
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017242 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017243 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17244 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17245 flags.
17246
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017247 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17248 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017249 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17250 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17251 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17252 the client connection was maintained open.
17253
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017254 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017255 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017256 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017257 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17258
17259
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172608.5. Session state at disconnection
17261-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017262
17263TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17264"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
172652-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17266each of which has a special meaning :
17267
17268 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17269 session to terminate :
17270
17271 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17272
17273 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17274 server explicitly refused it.
17275
17276 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17277 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17278 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17279 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017280 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017281
17282 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
17283 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017284
17285 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
17286 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
17287 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
17288 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
17289 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
17290
17291 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
17292 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
17293 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
17294 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
17295 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
17296
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090017297 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
17298 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
17299
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070017300 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
17301 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
17302 backup connections when going up.
17303
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020017304 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
17305
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017306 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
17307 send or receive data.
17308
17309 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
17310 send or receive data.
17311
17312 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
17313 with nothing left in the buffers.
17314
17315 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
17316
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010017317 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017318 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
17319
17320 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
17321 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
17322 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
17323 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
17324 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
17325
17326 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
17327 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
17328
17329 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
17330 server (HTTP only).
17331
17332 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
17333
17334 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
17335 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
17336 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
17337
17338 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
17339 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
17340 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
17341
17342 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
17343
17344 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
17345 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
17346
17347 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
17348 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
17349 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
17350
17351 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
17352 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020017353 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
17354 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017355
17356 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
17357 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
17358 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
17359 another server.
17360
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017361 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017362 server.
17363
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017364 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
17365 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
17366 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
17367 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17368
17369 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
17370 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
17371 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
17372 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17373
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020017374 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
17375 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
17376 "use-server" rule).
17377
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017378 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17379
17380 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
17381 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
17382
17383 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
17384
17385 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
17386 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
17387 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
17388
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017389 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
17390 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017391 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017392 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
17393 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
17394
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017395 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
17396
17397 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
17398 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
17399
17400 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
17401
17402 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17403
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017404The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
17405was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017406helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
17407starvation, attacks, etc...
17408
17409The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
17410alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
17411easier finding and understanding.
17412
17413 Flags Reason
17414
17415 -- Normal termination.
17416
17417 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
17418 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
17419 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
17420 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
17421
17422 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
17423 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
17424 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
17425 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
17426 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
17427 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017428
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017429 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17430 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017431 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017432
17433 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
17434 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
17435 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
17436
17437 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
17438 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
17439 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
17440 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
17441 the server takes too long to respond.
17442
17443 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
17444 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
17445 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
17446 long a time to respond.
17447
17448 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
17449 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
17450 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
17451 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017452 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
17453 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017454
17455 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
17456 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
17457 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
17458 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
17459 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020017460 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017461 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
17462 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
17463 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
17464 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
17465 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
17466 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
17467 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
17468 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017469 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017470 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
17471 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
17472 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017473
17474 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
17475 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017476 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
17477 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
17478 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
17479 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017480
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017481 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
17482 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
17483
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017484 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017485 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
17486 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017487 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017488 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
17489 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
17490
17491 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
17492 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
17493 503 or 504 here.
17494
17495 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
17496 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
17497 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
17498 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
17499 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
17500
17501 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17502 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017503 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017504 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
17505 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
17506
17507 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
17508 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
17509 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
17510 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
17511 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
17512 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
17513 between haproxy and the server.
17514
17515 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
17516 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
17517 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
17518 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
17519 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
17520 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
17521 solution is to fix the application.
17522
17523 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
17524 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
17525 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
17526 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
17527 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
17528 external attacks.
17529
17530 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
17531 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017532 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017533 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
17534 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
17535
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017536 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
17537 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
17538 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017539 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020017540 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017541
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017542 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
17543 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
17544 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
17545 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017546 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
17547 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
17548 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
17549 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
17550 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017551
17552 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
17553 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
17554 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
17555 returned an HTTP 403 error.
17556
17557 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
17558 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
17559 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
17560 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
17561
17562 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
17563 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
17564 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
17565 only be solved by proper system tuning.
17566
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017567The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
17568persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
17569important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
17570re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
17571
17572 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
17573
17574 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17575 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
17576 set on a GET request.
17577
17578 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
17579 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017580 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017581 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
17582
17583 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
17584 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
17585 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
17586
17587 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17588 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
17589 already got a cookie.
17590
17591 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17592 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
17593 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
17594 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
17595 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
17596
17597 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17598 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17599 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17600
17601 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
17602 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17603 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17604
17605 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
17606 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
17607
17608 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
17609 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
17610 then advertised in the response.
17611
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017612
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176138.6. Non-printable characters
17614-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017615
17616In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
17617consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
17618converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
17619prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
17620being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
17621escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
17622is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
17623'}' when logging headers.
17624
17625Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
17626issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
17627containing spaces is "User-Agent".
17628
17629Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
17630the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
17631performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
17632
17633
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176348.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
17635---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017636
17637Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
17638achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017639section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017640cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
17641the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
17642the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017643locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017644not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
17645user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
17646a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
17647wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
17648
17649 Examples :
17650 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
17651 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
17652
17653 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
17654 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
17655
17656
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176578.8. Capturing HTTP headers
17658---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017659
17660Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
17661proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
17662the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
17663server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
17664
17665Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
17666response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017667section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017668
17669It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017670time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
17671appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017672are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
17673and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
17674follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
17675request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
17676in the logs.
17677
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017678As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
17679frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
17680an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
17681
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017682 Example :
17683 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
17684 listen proxy-out
17685 mode http
17686 option httplog
17687 option logasap
17688 log global
17689 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
17690
17691 # log the name of the virtual server
17692 capture request header Host len 20
17693
17694 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
17695 capture request header Content-Length len 10
17696
17697 # log the beginning of the referrer
17698 capture request header Referer len 20
17699
17700 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
17701 capture response header Server len 20
17702
17703 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
17704 capture response header Content-Length len 10
17705
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017706 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017707 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
17708
17709 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
17710 capture response header Via len 20
17711
17712 # log the URL location during a redirection
17713 capture response header Location len 20
17714
17715 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
17716 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
17717 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17718 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
17719 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
17720
17721 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17722 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17723 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17724 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017725 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017726
17727 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17728 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17729 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17730 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
17731 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017732 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017733
17734
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177358.9. Examples of logs
17736---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017737
17738These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
17739them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
17740reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
17741
17742 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
17743 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17744 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17745
17746 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
17747 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
17748
17749 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
17750 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
17751 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17752
17753 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
17754 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
17755
17756 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
17757 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17758 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
17759
17760 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017761 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017762 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
17763 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
17764
17765 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
17766 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
17767 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
17768
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020017769 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
17770 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
17771 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
17772 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
17773 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
17774 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017775
17776 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017777 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017778
17779 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
17780 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
17781 Nothing was sent to any server.
17782
17783 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
17784 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
17785
17786 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
17787 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017788 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017789 send a 408 return code to the client.
17790
17791 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
17792 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
17793
17794 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
17795 5 seconds ("c----").
17796
17797 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
17798 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017799 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017800
17801 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017802 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017803 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
17804 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
17805 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
17806 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
17807 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017808
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020017809
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200178109. Supported filters
17811--------------------
17812
17813Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
17814accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
17815unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
17816
17817See also : "filter"
17818
178199.1. Trace
17820----------
17821
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017822filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017823
17824 Arguments:
17825 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
17826 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
17827
17828 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
17829 the client and the server. By default, this filter
17830 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
17831 only parses a random amount of the available data.
17832
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017833 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017834 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
17835 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
17836 amount of the parsed data.
17837
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017838 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017839
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017840This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
17841callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
17842information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
17843filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
17844
17845Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
17846tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
17847a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
17848
17849
178509.2. HTTP compression
17851---------------------
17852
17853filter compression
17854
17855The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
17856keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017857when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache enabled,
17858it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always done after the
17859response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter
17860line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one filter other than the
17861cache is used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know
17862the filters evaluation order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017863
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017864See also : "compression" and section 9.4 about the cache filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017865
17866
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200178679.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
17868--------------------------------------------
17869
17870filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
17871
17872 Arguments :
17873
17874 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
17875 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
17876 parsed.
17877
17878 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
17879 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
17880 part must be placed in its own scope.
17881
17882The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
17883external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017884streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017885exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
17886also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
17887
17888SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
17889the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
17890
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017891For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017892"doc/SPOE.txt".
17893
17894Important note:
17895 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
17896 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
17897
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100178989.4. Cache
17899----------
17900
17901filter cache <name>
17902
17903 Arguments :
17904
17905 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
17906
17907The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
17908"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017909cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017910other filters than cache or compression are used, it is enough. In such case,
17911the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it is
17912mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
17913filter other than the compression is used for the same
17914listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
17915order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010017916
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020017917See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter and section 6 about cache.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017918
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017919/*
17920 * Local variables:
17921 * fill-column: 79
17922 * End:
17923 */